rds

package
v1.13.40-0...-52d5a98 Latest Latest
Warning

This package is not in the latest version of its module.

Go to latest
Published: Apr 30, 2018 License: Apache-2.0 Imports: 10 Imported by: 0

Documentation

Overview

Package rds provides the client and types for making API requests to Amazon Relational Database Service.

Amazon Relational Database Service (Amazon RDS) is a web service that makes it easier to set up, operate, and scale a relational database in the cloud. It provides cost-efficient, resizable capacity for an industry-standard relational database and manages common database administration tasks, freeing up developers to focus on what makes their applications and businesses unique.

Amazon RDS gives you access to the capabilities of a MySQL, MariaDB, PostgreSQL, Microsoft SQL Server, Oracle, or Amazon Aurora database server. These capabilities mean that the code, applications, and tools you already use today with your existing databases work with Amazon RDS without modification. Amazon RDS automatically backs up your database and maintains the database software that powers your DB instance. Amazon RDS is flexible: you can scale your DB instance's compute resources and storage capacity to meet your application's demand. As with all Amazon Web Services, there are no up-front investments, and you pay only for the resources you use.

This interface reference for Amazon RDS contains documentation for a programming or command line interface you can use to manage Amazon RDS. Note that Amazon RDS is asynchronous, which means that some interfaces might require techniques such as polling or callback functions to determine when a command has been applied. In this reference, the parameter descriptions indicate whether a command is applied immediately, on the next instance reboot, or during the maintenance window. The reference structure is as follows, and we list following some related topics from the user guide.

Amazon RDS API Reference

Amazon RDS User Guide

See https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31 for more information on this service.

See rds package documentation for more information. https://docs.aws.amazon.com/sdk-for-go/api/service/rds/

Using the Client

To contact Amazon Relational Database Service with the SDK use the New function to create a new service client. With that client you can make API requests to the service. These clients are safe to use concurrently.

See the SDK's documentation for more information on how to use the SDK. https://docs.aws.amazon.com/sdk-for-go/api/

See aws.Config documentation for more information on configuring SDK clients. https://docs.aws.amazon.com/sdk-for-go/api/aws/#Config

See the Amazon Relational Database Service client RDS for more information on creating client for this service. https://docs.aws.amazon.com/sdk-for-go/api/service/rds/#New

IAM User or Role Database Authentication

The rdsutil package's BuildAuthToken function provides a connection authentication token builder. Given an endpoint of the RDS database, AWS region, DB user, and AWS credentials the function will create an presigned URL to use as the authentication token for the database's connection.

The following example shows how to use BuildAuthToken to create an authentication token for connecting to a MySQL database in RDS.

authToken, err := rdsutils.BuildAuthToken(dbEndpoint, awsRegion, dbUser, awsCreds)

// Create the MySQL DNS string for the DB connection
// user:password@protocol(endpoint)/dbname?<params>
dnsStr = fmt.Sprintf("%s:%s@tcp(%s)/%s?tls=true",
   dbUser, authToken, dbEndpoint, dbName,
)

// Use db to perform SQL operations on database
db, err := sql.Open("mysql", dnsStr)

See rdsutil package for more information. http://docs.aws.amazon.com/sdk-for-go/api/service/rds/rdsutils/

Index

Examples

Constants

View Source
const (
	// ApplyMethodImmediate is a ApplyMethod enum value
	ApplyMethodImmediate = "immediate"

	// ApplyMethodPendingReboot is a ApplyMethod enum value
	ApplyMethodPendingReboot = "pending-reboot"
)
View Source
const (
	// SourceTypeDbInstance is a SourceType enum value
	SourceTypeDbInstance = "db-instance"

	// SourceTypeDbParameterGroup is a SourceType enum value
	SourceTypeDbParameterGroup = "db-parameter-group"

	// SourceTypeDbSecurityGroup is a SourceType enum value
	SourceTypeDbSecurityGroup = "db-security-group"

	// SourceTypeDbSnapshot is a SourceType enum value
	SourceTypeDbSnapshot = "db-snapshot"

	// SourceTypeDbCluster is a SourceType enum value
	SourceTypeDbCluster = "db-cluster"

	// SourceTypeDbClusterSnapshot is a SourceType enum value
	SourceTypeDbClusterSnapshot = "db-cluster-snapshot"
)
View Source
const (

	// ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "AuthorizationAlreadyExists".
	//
	// The specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is already authorized for the
	// specified DB security group.
	ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault = "AuthorizationAlreadyExists"

	// ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "AuthorizationNotFound".
	//
	// Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified
	// DB security group.
	//
	// RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your
	// behalf.
	ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault = "AuthorizationNotFound"

	// ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "AuthorizationQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// DB security group authorization quota has been reached.
	ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault = "AuthorizationQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "CertificateNotFound".
	//
	// CertificateIdentifier does not refer to an existing certificate.
	ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault = "CertificateNotFound"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault".
	//
	// User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.
	ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault = "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterNotFoundFault".
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.
	ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault = "DBClusterNotFoundFault"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound".
	//
	// DBClusterParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB Cluster parameter
	// group.
	ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault = "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault".
	//
	// User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached
	// the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.
	ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault = "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterRoleAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterRoleAlreadyExists".
	//
	// The specified IAM role Amazon Resource Name (ARN) is already associated with
	// the specified DB cluster.
	ErrCodeDBClusterRoleAlreadyExistsFault = "DBClusterRoleAlreadyExists"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterRoleNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterRoleNotFound".
	//
	// The specified IAM role Amazon Resource Name (ARN) is not associated with
	// the specified DB cluster.
	ErrCodeDBClusterRoleNotFoundFault = "DBClusterRoleNotFound"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterRoleQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterRoleQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// You have exceeded the maximum number of IAM roles that can be associated
	// with the specified DB cluster.
	ErrCodeDBClusterRoleQuotaExceededFault = "DBClusterRoleQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault".
	//
	// User already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.
	ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault = "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault"

	// ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault".
	//
	// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.
	ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault = "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault"

	// ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "DBInstanceAlreadyExists".
	//
	// User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.
	ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault = "DBInstanceAlreadyExists"

	// ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBInstanceNotFound".
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.
	ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault = "DBInstanceNotFound"

	// ErrCodeDBLogFileNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBLogFileNotFoundFault".
	//
	// LogFileName does not refer to an existing DB log file.
	ErrCodeDBLogFileNotFoundFault = "DBLogFileNotFoundFault"

	// ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists".
	//
	// A DB parameter group with the same name exists.
	ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault = "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists"

	// ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBParameterGroupNotFound".
	//
	// DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.
	ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault = "DBParameterGroupNotFound"

	// ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter
	// groups.
	ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault = "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "DBSecurityGroupAlreadyExists".
	//
	// A DB security group with the name specified in DBSecurityGroupName already
	// exists.
	ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupAlreadyExistsFault = "DBSecurityGroupAlreadyExists"

	// ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBSecurityGroupNotFound".
	//
	// DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.
	ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault = "DBSecurityGroupNotFound"

	// ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotSupportedFault for service response error code
	// "DBSecurityGroupNotSupported".
	//
	// A DB security group is not allowed for this action.
	ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotSupportedFault = "DBSecurityGroupNotSupported"

	// ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "QuotaExceeded.DBSecurityGroup".
	//
	// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB security
	// groups.
	ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupQuotaExceededFault = "QuotaExceeded.DBSecurityGroup"

	// ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists".
	//
	// DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.
	ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault = "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists"

	// ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBSnapshotNotFound".
	//
	// DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.
	ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault = "DBSnapshotNotFound"

	// ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "DBSubnetGroupAlreadyExists".
	//
	// DBSubnetGroupName is already used by an existing DB subnet group.
	ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupAlreadyExistsFault = "DBSubnetGroupAlreadyExists"

	// ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs for service response error code
	// "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs".
	//
	// Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones
	// unless there is only one Availability Zone.
	ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs = "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs"

	// ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault for service response error code
	// "DBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault".
	//
	// Indicates that the DBSubnetGroup should not be specified while creating read
	// replicas that lie in the same region as the source instance.
	ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault = "DBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault"

	// ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault".
	//
	// DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.
	ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault = "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault"

	// ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "DBSubnetGroupQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB subnet groups.
	ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupQuotaExceededFault = "DBSubnetGroupQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "DBSubnetQuotaExceededFault".
	//
	// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of subnets in a
	// DB subnet groups.
	ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault = "DBSubnetQuotaExceededFault"

	// ErrCodeDBUpgradeDependencyFailureFault for service response error code
	// "DBUpgradeDependencyFailure".
	//
	// The DB upgrade failed because a resource the DB depends on could not be modified.
	ErrCodeDBUpgradeDependencyFailureFault = "DBUpgradeDependencyFailure"

	// ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "DomainNotFoundFault".
	//
	// Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.
	ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault = "DomainNotFoundFault"

	// ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// You have reached the maximum number of event subscriptions.
	ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault = "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "InstanceQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.
	ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault = "InstanceQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault for service response error code
	// "InsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault".
	//
	// The DB cluster does not have enough capacity for the current operation.
	ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault = "InsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault"

	// ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault for service response error code
	// "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity".
	//
	// Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability
	// Zone.
	ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault = "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity"

	// ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault for service response error code
	// "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity".
	//
	// There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be
	// able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different
	// Availability Zones that have more storage available.
	ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault = "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault".
	//
	// The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault = "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBClusterStateFault".
	//
	// The DB cluster is not in a valid state.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault = "InvalidDBClusterStateFault"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBInstanceState".
	//
	// The specified DB instance is not in the available state.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault = "InvalidDBInstanceState"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBParameterGroupState".
	//
	// The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting
	// to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group
	// is in this state.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault = "InvalidDBParameterGroupState"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState".
	//
	// The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault = "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBSnapshotState".
	//
	// The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault = "InvalidDBSnapshotState"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBSubnetGroupFault".
	//
	// Indicates the DBSubnetGroup does not belong to the same VPC as that of an
	// existing cross region read replica of the same source instance.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupFault = "InvalidDBSubnetGroupFault"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault".
	//
	// The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault = "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault"

	// ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidDBSubnetStateFault".
	//
	// The DB subnet is not in the available state.
	ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetStateFault = "InvalidDBSubnetStateFault"

	// ErrCodeInvalidEventSubscriptionStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidEventSubscriptionState".
	//
	// This error can occur if someone else is modifying a subscription. You should
	// retry the action.
	ErrCodeInvalidEventSubscriptionStateFault = "InvalidEventSubscriptionState"

	// ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidOptionGroupStateFault".
	//
	// The option group is not in the available state.
	ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault = "InvalidOptionGroupStateFault"

	// ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidRestoreFault".
	//
	// Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.
	ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault = "InvalidRestoreFault"

	// ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidS3BucketFault".
	//
	// The specified Amazon S3 bucket name could not be found or Amazon RDS is not
	// authorized to access the specified Amazon S3 bucket. Verify the SourceS3BucketName
	// and S3IngestionRoleArn values and try again.
	ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketFault = "InvalidS3BucketFault"

	// ErrCodeInvalidSubnet for service response error code
	// "InvalidSubnet".
	//
	// The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that
	// are not all in a common VPC.
	ErrCodeInvalidSubnet = "InvalidSubnet"

	// ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault for service response error code
	// "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault".
	//
	// DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created
	// because users' change.
	ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault = "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault"

	// ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault for service response error code
	// "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault".
	//
	// Error accessing KMS key.
	ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault = "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault"

	// ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "OptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault".
	//
	// The option group you are trying to create already exists.
	ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault = "OptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault"

	// ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "OptionGroupNotFoundFault".
	//
	// The specified option group could not be found.
	ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault = "OptionGroupNotFoundFault"

	// ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "OptionGroupQuotaExceededFault".
	//
	// The quota of 20 option groups was exceeded for this AWS account.
	ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault = "OptionGroupQuotaExceededFault"

	// ErrCodePointInTimeRestoreNotEnabledFault for service response error code
	// "PointInTimeRestoreNotEnabled".
	//
	// SourceDBInstanceIdentifier refers to a DB instance with BackupRetentionPeriod
	// equal to 0.
	ErrCodePointInTimeRestoreNotEnabledFault = "PointInTimeRestoreNotEnabled"

	// ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault for service response error code
	// "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault".
	//
	// Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.
	ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault = "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault"

	// ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault for service response error code
	// "ReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExists".
	//
	// User already has a reservation with the given identifier.
	ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault = "ReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExists"

	// ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "ReservedDBInstanceNotFound".
	//
	// The specified reserved DB Instance not found.
	ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceNotFoundFault = "ReservedDBInstanceNotFound"

	// ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "ReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// Request would exceed the user's DB Instance quota.
	ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceededFault = "ReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "ReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFound".
	//
	// Specified offering does not exist.
	ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault = "ReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFound"

	// ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "ResourceNotFoundFault".
	//
	// The specified resource ID was not found.
	ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault = "ResourceNotFoundFault"

	// ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault for service response error code
	// "SNSInvalidTopic".
	//
	// SNS has responded that there is a problem with the SND topic specified.
	ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault = "SNSInvalidTopic"

	// ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault for service response error code
	// "SNSNoAuthorization".
	//
	// You do not have permission to publish to the SNS topic ARN.
	ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault = "SNSNoAuthorization"

	// ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "SNSTopicArnNotFound".
	//
	// The SNS topic ARN does not exist.
	ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault = "SNSTopicArnNotFound"

	// ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "SharedSnapshotQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// You have exceeded the maximum number of accounts that you can share a manual
	// DB snapshot with.
	ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault = "SharedSnapshotQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "SnapshotQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.
	ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault = "SnapshotQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "SourceNotFound".
	//
	// The requested source could not be found.
	ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault = "SourceNotFound"

	// ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault for service response error code
	// "StorageQuotaExceeded".
	//
	// Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available
	// across all DB instances.
	ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault = "StorageQuotaExceeded"

	// ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault for service response error code
	// "StorageTypeNotSupported".
	//
	// StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.
	ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault = "StorageTypeNotSupported"

	// ErrCodeSubnetAlreadyInUse for service response error code
	// "SubnetAlreadyInUse".
	//
	// The DB subnet is already in use in the Availability Zone.
	ErrCodeSubnetAlreadyInUse = "SubnetAlreadyInUse"

	// ErrCodeSubscriptionAlreadyExistFault for service response error code
	// "SubscriptionAlreadyExist".
	//
	// The supplied subscription name already exists.
	ErrCodeSubscriptionAlreadyExistFault = "SubscriptionAlreadyExist"

	// ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound".
	//
	// The supplied category does not exist.
	ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault = "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound"

	// ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault for service response error code
	// "SubscriptionNotFound".
	//
	// The subscription name does not exist.
	ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault = "SubscriptionNotFound"
)
View Source
const (
	ServiceName = "rds"       // Service endpoint prefix API calls made to.
	EndpointsID = ServiceName // Service ID for Regions and Endpoints metadata.
)

Service information constants

Variables

This section is empty.

Functions

This section is empty.

Types

type AccountQuota

type AccountQuota struct {

	// The name of the Amazon RDS quota for this AWS account.
	AccountQuotaName *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum allowed value for the quota.
	Max *int64 `type:"long"`

	// The amount currently used toward the quota maximum.
	Used *int64 `type:"long"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Describes a quota for an AWS account, for example, the number of DB instances allowed.

func (AccountQuota) GoString

func (s AccountQuota) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*AccountQuota) SetAccountQuotaName

func (s *AccountQuota) SetAccountQuotaName(v string) *AccountQuota

SetAccountQuotaName sets the AccountQuotaName field's value.

func (*AccountQuota) SetMax

func (s *AccountQuota) SetMax(v int64) *AccountQuota

SetMax sets the Max field's value.

func (*AccountQuota) SetUsed

func (s *AccountQuota) SetUsed(v int64) *AccountQuota

SetUsed sets the Used field's value.

func (AccountQuota) String

func (s AccountQuota) String() string

String returns the string representation

type AddRoleToDBClusterInput

type AddRoleToDBClusterInput struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster to associate the IAM role with.
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role to associate with the Aurora
	// DB cluster, for example arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/AuroraAccessRole.
	//
	// RoleArn is a required field
	RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (AddRoleToDBClusterInput) GoString

func (s AddRoleToDBClusterInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*AddRoleToDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *AddRoleToDBClusterInput

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*AddRoleToDBClusterInput) SetRoleArn

SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.

func (AddRoleToDBClusterInput) String

func (s AddRoleToDBClusterInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*AddRoleToDBClusterInput) Validate

func (s *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type AddRoleToDBClusterOutput

type AddRoleToDBClusterOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) GoString

func (s AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) String

func (s AddRoleToDBClusterOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput

type AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput struct {

	// The identifier of the event source to be added.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If the source type is a DB instance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must
	//    be supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is a DB security group, a DBSecurityGroupName must
	//    be supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is a DB parameter group, a DBParameterGroupName must
	//    be supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is a DB snapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be
	//    supplied.
	//
	// SourceIdentifier is a required field
	SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to add a source
	// identifier to.
	//
	// SubscriptionName is a required field
	SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIdentifier

SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.

func (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName

SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.

func (AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput

type AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
	// action.
	EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription

SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.

func (AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type AddTagsToResourceInput

type AddTagsToResourceInput struct {

	// The Amazon RDS resource that the tags are added to. This value is an Amazon
	// Resource Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see  Constructing
	// an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
	//
	// ResourceName is a required field
	ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The tags to be assigned to the Amazon RDS resource.
	//
	// Tags is a required field
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (AddTagsToResourceInput) GoString

func (s AddTagsToResourceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*AddTagsToResourceInput) SetResourceName

func (s *AddTagsToResourceInput) SetResourceName(v string) *AddTagsToResourceInput

SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.

func (*AddTagsToResourceInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (AddTagsToResourceInput) String

func (s AddTagsToResourceInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*AddTagsToResourceInput) Validate

func (s *AddTagsToResourceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type AddTagsToResourceOutput

type AddTagsToResourceOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (AddTagsToResourceOutput) GoString

func (s AddTagsToResourceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (AddTagsToResourceOutput) String

func (s AddTagsToResourceOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput

type ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput struct {

	// The pending maintenance action to apply to this resource.
	//
	// Valid values: system-update, db-upgrade
	//
	// ApplyAction is a required field
	ApplyAction *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A value that specifies the type of opt-in request, or undoes an opt-in request.
	// An opt-in request of type immediate can't be undone.
	//
	// Valid values:
	//
	//    * immediate - Apply the maintenance action immediately.
	//
	//    * next-maintenance - Apply the maintenance action during the next maintenance
	//    window for the resource.
	//
	//    * undo-opt-in - Cancel any existing next-maintenance opt-in requests.
	//
	// OptInType is a required field
	OptInType *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the resource that the pending maintenance
	// action applies to. For information about creating an ARN, see  Constructing
	// an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
	//
	// ResourceIdentifier is a required field
	ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetApplyAction

SetApplyAction sets the ApplyAction field's value.

func (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetOptInType

SetOptInType sets the OptInType field's value.

func (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) SetResourceIdentifier

SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.

func (ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput

type ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput struct {

	// Describes the pending maintenance actions for a resource.
	ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions *ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) SetResourcePendingMaintenanceActions

SetResourcePendingMaintenanceActions sets the ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions field's value.

func (ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput

type AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput struct {

	// The IP range to authorize.
	CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the DB security group to add authorization to.
	//
	// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
	DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Id of the EC2 security group to authorize. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId
	// must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName
	// or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
	EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`

	// Name of the EC2 security group to authorize. For VPC DB security groups,
	// EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and
	// either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
	EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// AWS account number of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in the
	// EC2SecurityGroupName parameter. The AWS Access Key ID is not an acceptable
	// value. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise,
	// EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId
	// must be provided.
	EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetCIDRIP

SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.

func (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName

SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupId

SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.

func (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupName

SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId

SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.

func (AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput

type AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput struct {

	// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
	// action.
	DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup

SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.

func (AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type AvailabilityZone

type AvailabilityZone struct {

	// The name of the availability zone.
	Name *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains Availability Zone information.

This data type is used as an element in the following data type:

  • OrderableDBInstanceOption

func (AvailabilityZone) GoString

func (s AvailabilityZone) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*AvailabilityZone) SetName

func (s *AvailabilityZone) SetName(v string) *AvailabilityZone

SetName sets the Name field's value.

func (AvailabilityZone) String

func (s AvailabilityZone) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Certificate

type Certificate struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the certificate.
	CertificateArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The unique key that identifies a certificate.
	CertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The type of the certificate.
	CertificateType *string `type:"string"`

	// The thumbprint of the certificate.
	Thumbprint *string `type:"string"`

	// The starting date from which the certificate is valid.
	ValidFrom *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// The final date that the certificate continues to be valid.
	ValidTill *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

A CA certificate for an AWS account.

func (Certificate) GoString

func (s Certificate) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Certificate) SetCertificateArn

func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateArn(v string) *Certificate

SetCertificateArn sets the CertificateArn field's value.

func (*Certificate) SetCertificateIdentifier

func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateIdentifier(v string) *Certificate

SetCertificateIdentifier sets the CertificateIdentifier field's value.

func (*Certificate) SetCertificateType

func (s *Certificate) SetCertificateType(v string) *Certificate

SetCertificateType sets the CertificateType field's value.

func (*Certificate) SetThumbprint

func (s *Certificate) SetThumbprint(v string) *Certificate

SetThumbprint sets the Thumbprint field's value.

func (*Certificate) SetValidFrom

func (s *Certificate) SetValidFrom(v time.Time) *Certificate

SetValidFrom sets the ValidFrom field's value.

func (*Certificate) SetValidTill

func (s *Certificate) SetValidTill(v time.Time) *Certificate

SetValidTill sets the ValidTill field's value.

func (Certificate) String

func (s Certificate) String() string

String returns the string representation

type CharacterSet

type CharacterSet struct {

	// The description of the character set.
	CharacterSetDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the character set.
	CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the action DescribeDBEngineVersions.

func (CharacterSet) GoString

func (s CharacterSet) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CharacterSet) SetCharacterSetDescription

func (s *CharacterSet) SetCharacterSetDescription(v string) *CharacterSet

SetCharacterSetDescription sets the CharacterSetDescription field's value.

func (*CharacterSet) SetCharacterSetName

func (s *CharacterSet) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CharacterSet

SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.

func (CharacterSet) String

func (s CharacterSet) String() string

String returns the string representation

type CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration

type CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration struct {

	// The list of log types to disable.
	DisableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`

	// The list of log types to enable.
	EnableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

The configuration setting for the log types to be enabled for export to CloudWatch Logs for a specific DB instance or DB cluster.

func (CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) SetDisableLogTypes

SetDisableLogTypes sets the DisableLogTypes field's value.

func (*CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) SetEnableLogTypes

SetEnableLogTypes sets the EnableLogTypes field's value.

func (CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) String

String returns the string representation

type CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput

type CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The identifier or Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the source DB cluster parameter
	// group. For information about creating an ARN, see  Constructing an RDS Amazon
	// Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must specify a valid DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	//    * If the source DB cluster parameter group is in the same AWS Region as
	//    the copy, specify a valid DB parameter group identifier, for example my-db-cluster-param-group,
	//    or a valid ARN.
	//
	//    * If the source DB parameter group is in a different AWS Region than the
	//    copy, specify a valid DB cluster parameter group ARN, for example arn:aws:rds:us-east-1:123456789012:cluster-pg:custom-cluster-group1.
	//
	// SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
	SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// A description for the copied DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	// TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription is a required field
	TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The identifier for the copied DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: my-cluster-param-group1
	//
	// TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
	TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetSourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier

func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetSourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput

SetSourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription

func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput

SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription sets the TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier

func (s *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput

SetTargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier sets the TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.

func (CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput

type CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
	// action.
	DBClusterParameterGroup *DBClusterParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroup

SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.

func (CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput

type CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {

	// True to copy all tags from the source DB cluster snapshot to the target DB
	// cluster snapshot, and otherwise false. The default is false.
	CopyTags *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
	DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted DB cluster snapshot. The KMS key
	// ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key
	// alias for the KMS encryption key.
	//
	// If you copy an unencrypted DB cluster snapshot and specify a value for the
	// KmsKeyId parameter, Amazon RDS encrypts the target DB cluster snapshot using
	// the specified KMS encryption key.
	//
	// If you copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from your AWS account, you can
	// specify a value for KmsKeyId to encrypt the copy with a new KMS encryption
	// key. If you don't specify a value for KmsKeyId, then the copy of the DB cluster
	// snapshot is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB cluster snapshot.
	//
	// If you copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot that is shared from another
	// AWS account, then you must specify a value for KmsKeyId.
	//
	// To copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot to another AWS Region, you must
	// set KmsKeyId to the KMS key ID you want to use to encrypt the copy of the
	// DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys are
	// specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use encryption
	// keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot
	// API action in the AWS Region that contains the source DB cluster snapshot
	// to copy. The PreSignedUrl parameter must be used when copying an encrypted
	// DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region.
	//
	// The pre-signed URL must be a valid request for the CopyDBSClusterSnapshot
	// API action that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the
	// encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. The pre-signed URL request must
	// contain the following parameter values:
	//
	//    * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
	//    the copy of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This
	//    is the same identifier for both the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action that
	//    is called in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the
	//    pre-signed URL.
	//
	//    * DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that the DB cluster snapshot
	//    will be created in.
	//
	//    * SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier
	//    for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must
	//    be in the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region.
	//    For example, if you are copying an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from
	//    the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier
	//    looks like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster-snapshot:aurora-cluster1-snapshot-20161115.
	//
	// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see  Authenticating
	// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
	// and  Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
	PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`

	// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot to copy. This parameter is not
	// case-sensitive.
	//
	// You can't copy an encrypted, shared DB cluster snapshot from one AWS Region
	// to another.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must specify a valid system snapshot in the "available" state.
	//
	//    * If the source snapshot is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify
	//    a valid DB snapshot identifier.
	//
	//    * If the source snapshot is in a different AWS Region than the copy, specify
	//    a valid DB cluster snapshot ARN. For more information, go to  Copying
	//    a DB Snapshot or DB Cluster Snapshot (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html).
	//
	// Example: my-cluster-snapshot1
	//
	// SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
	// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
	// have the same region as the source ARN.
	SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// The identifier of the new DB cluster snapshot to create from the source DB
	// cluster snapshot. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	//
	// Example: my-cluster-snapshot2
	//
	// TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString

func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetCopyTags

SetCopyTags sets the CopyTags field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDestinationRegion

func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput

SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetPreSignedUrl

SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput

SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetSourceRegion

SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput

SetTargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate

func (s *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput

type CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
	// action.
	DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString

func (s CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot

SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.

func (CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CopyDBParameterGroupInput

type CopyDBParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The identifier or ARN for the source DB parameter group. For information
	// about creating an ARN, see  Constructing an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN)
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must specify a valid DB parameter group.
	//
	//    * Must specify a valid DB parameter group identifier, for example my-db-param-group,
	//    or a valid ARN.
	//
	// SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
	SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// A description for the copied DB parameter group.
	//
	// TargetDBParameterGroupDescription is a required field
	TargetDBParameterGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The identifier for the copied DB parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: my-db-parameter-group
	//
	// TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier is a required field
	TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyDBParameterGroupInput) GoString

func (s CopyDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetSourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier

func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetSourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput

SetSourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier sets the SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.

func (*CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBParameterGroupDescription

func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBParameterGroupDescription(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput

SetTargetDBParameterGroupDescription sets the TargetDBParameterGroupDescription field's value.

func (*CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier

func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) SetTargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBParameterGroupInput

SetTargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier sets the TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier field's value.

func (CopyDBParameterGroupInput) String

func (s CopyDBParameterGroupInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBParameterGroupInput) Validate

func (s *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CopyDBParameterGroupOutput

type CopyDBParameterGroupOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups
	// action.
	DBParameterGroup *DBParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString

func (s CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) SetDBParameterGroup

SetDBParameterGroup sets the DBParameterGroup field's value.

func (CopyDBParameterGroupOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CopyDBSnapshotInput

type CopyDBSnapshotInput struct {

	// True to copy all tags from the source DB snapshot to the target DB snapshot,
	// and otherwise false. The default is false.
	CopyTags *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
	DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted DB snapshot. The KMS key ID is the Amazon
	// Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key alias for the KMS
	// encryption key.
	//
	// If you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from your AWS account, you can specify
	// a value for this parameter to encrypt the copy with a new KMS encryption
	// key. If you don't specify a value for this parameter, then the copy of the
	// DB snapshot is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB snapshot.
	//
	// If you copy an encrypted DB snapshot that is shared from another AWS account,
	// then you must specify a value for this parameter.
	//
	// If you specify this parameter when you copy an unencrypted snapshot, the
	// copy is encrypted.
	//
	// If you copy an encrypted snapshot to a different AWS Region, then you must
	// specify a KMS key for the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys are
	// specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use encryption
	// keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of an option group to associate with the copy of the snapshot.
	//
	// Specify this option if you are copying a snapshot from one AWS Region to
	// another, and your DB instance uses a nondefault option group. If your source
	// DB instance uses Transparent Data Encryption for Oracle or Microsoft SQL
	// Server, you must specify this option when copying across AWS Regions. For
	// more information, see Option Group Considerations (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html#USER_CopySnapshot.Options).
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CopyDBSnapshot
	// API action in the source AWS Region that contains the source DB snapshot
	// to copy.
	//
	// You must specify this parameter when you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from
	// another AWS Region by using the Amazon RDS API. You can specify the --source-region
	// option instead of this parameter when you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from
	// another AWS Region by using the AWS CLI.
	//
	// The presigned URL must be a valid request for the CopyDBSnapshot API action
	// that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted
	// DB snapshot to be copied. The presigned URL request must contain the following
	// parameter values:
	//
	//    * DestinationRegion - The AWS Region that the encrypted DB snapshot is
	//    copied to. This AWS Region is the same one where the CopyDBSnapshot action
	//    is called that contains this presigned URL.
	//
	// For example, if you copy an encrypted DB snapshot from the us-west-2 AWS
	//    Region to the us-east-1 AWS Region, then you call the CopyDBSnapshot action
	//    in the us-east-1 AWS Region and provide a presigned URL that contains
	//    a call to the CopyDBSnapshot action in the us-west-2 AWS Region. For this
	//    example, the DestinationRegion in the presigned URL must be set to the
	//    us-east-1 AWS Region.
	//
	//    * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
	//    the copy of the DB snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This is the
	//    same identifier for both the CopyDBSnapshot action that is called in the
	//    destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the presigned URL.
	//
	//
	//    * SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier - The DB snapshot identifier for the encrypted
	//    snapshot to be copied. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
	//    Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are copying
	//    an encrypted DB snapshot from the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier
	//    looks like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20161115.
	//
	//
	// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
	// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
	// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
	PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`

	// The identifier for the source DB snapshot.
	//
	// If the source snapshot is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify a valid
	// DB snapshot identifier. For example, you might specify rds:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805.
	//
	// If the source snapshot is in a different AWS Region than the copy, specify
	// a valid DB snapshot ARN. For example, you might specify arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805.
	//
	// If you are copying from a shared manual DB snapshot, this parameter must
	// be the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the shared DB snapshot.
	//
	// If you are copying an encrypted snapshot this parameter must be in the ARN
	// format for the source AWS Region, and must match the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier
	// in the PreSignedUrl parameter.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must specify a valid system snapshot in the "available" state.
	//
	// Example: rds:mydb-2012-04-02-00-01
	//
	// Example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:snapshot:mysql-instance1-snapshot-20130805
	//
	// SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
	// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
	// have the same region as the source ARN.
	SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// The identifier for the copy of the snapshot.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: my-db-snapshot
	//
	// TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyDBSnapshotInput) GoString

func (s CopyDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetCopyTags

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetCopyTags(v bool) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetCopyTags sets the CopyTags field's value.

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetDestinationRegion

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetPreSignedUrl

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetSourceRegion

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetTags

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetTargetDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) SetTargetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CopyDBSnapshotInput

SetTargetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (CopyDBSnapshotInput) String

func (s CopyDBSnapshotInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBSnapshotInput) Validate

func (s *CopyDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CopyDBSnapshotOutput

type CopyDBSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
	DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyDBSnapshotOutput) GoString

func (s CopyDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot

SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.

func (CopyDBSnapshotOutput) String

func (s CopyDBSnapshotOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type CopyOptionGroupInput

type CopyOptionGroupInput struct {

	// The identifier or ARN for the source option group. For information about
	// creating an ARN, see  Constructing an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must specify a valid option group.
	//
	//    * If the source option group is in the same AWS Region as the copy, specify
	//    a valid option group identifier, for example my-option-group, or a valid
	//    ARN.
	//
	//    * If the source option group is in a different AWS Region than the copy,
	//    specify a valid option group ARN, for example arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:og:special-options.
	//
	// SourceOptionGroupIdentifier is a required field
	SourceOptionGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// The description for the copied option group.
	//
	// TargetOptionGroupDescription is a required field
	TargetOptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The identifier for the copied option group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: my-option-group
	//
	// TargetOptionGroupIdentifier is a required field
	TargetOptionGroupIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyOptionGroupInput) GoString

func (s CopyOptionGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyOptionGroupInput) SetSourceOptionGroupIdentifier

func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetSourceOptionGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput

SetSourceOptionGroupIdentifier sets the SourceOptionGroupIdentifier field's value.

func (*CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTags

func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CopyOptionGroupInput

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTargetOptionGroupDescription

func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTargetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput

SetTargetOptionGroupDescription sets the TargetOptionGroupDescription field's value.

func (*CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTargetOptionGroupIdentifier

func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) SetTargetOptionGroupIdentifier(v string) *CopyOptionGroupInput

SetTargetOptionGroupIdentifier sets the TargetOptionGroupIdentifier field's value.

func (CopyOptionGroupInput) String

func (s CopyOptionGroupInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*CopyOptionGroupInput) Validate

func (s *CopyOptionGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CopyOptionGroupOutput

type CopyOptionGroupOutput struct {
	OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CopyOptionGroupOutput) GoString

func (s CopyOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CopyOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup

SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.

func (CopyOptionGroupOutput) String

func (s CopyOptionGroupOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBClusterInput

type CreateDBClusterInput struct {

	// A list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster can be
	// created in. For information on AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions
	// and Availability Zones (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html).
	AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`

	// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. You must specify
	// a minimum value of 1.
	//
	// Default: 1
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be a value from 1 to 35
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
	// specified CharacterSet.
	CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB cluster identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	//
	// Example: my-cluster1
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to associate with this DB cluster.
	// If this argument is omitted, default.aurora5.6 is used.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB cluster.
	//
	// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
	// default.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The name for your database of up to 64 alpha-numeric characters. If you do
	// not provide a name, Amazon RDS will not create a database in the DB cluster
	// you are creating.
	DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`

	// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
	DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the database engine to be used for this DB cluster.
	//
	// Valid Values: aurora (for MySQL 5.6-compatible Aurora), aurora-mysql (for
	// MySQL 5.7-compatible Aurora), and aurora-postgresql
	//
	// Engine is a required field
	Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The version number of the database engine to use.
	//
	// Aurora MySQL
	//
	// Example: 5.6.10a, 5.7.12
	//
	// Aurora PostgreSQL
	//
	// Example: 9.6.3
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB cluster.
	//
	// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
	// key. If you are creating a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
	// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
	// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
	//
	// If an encryption key is not specified in KmsKeyId:
	//
	//    * If ReplicationSourceIdentifier identifies an encrypted source, then
	//    Amazon RDS will use the encryption key used to encrypt the source. Otherwise,
	//    Amazon RDS will use your default encryption key.
	//
	//    * If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true and ReplicationSourceIdentifier
	//    is not specified, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption key.
	//
	// AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your AWS
	// account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
	//
	// If you create a Read Replica of an encrypted DB cluster in another AWS Region,
	// you must set KmsKeyId to a KMS key ID that is valid in the destination AWS
	// Region. This key is used to encrypt the Read Replica in that AWS Region.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The password for the master database user. This password can contain any
	// printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
	MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the master user for the DB cluster.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
	MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`

	// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
	// specified option group.
	//
	// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. The option group
	// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the instances in the DB cluster accept connections.
	//
	// Default: 3306 if engine is set as aurora or 5432 if set to aurora-postgresql.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// A URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CreateDBCluster
	// action to be called in the source AWS Region where the DB cluster is replicated
	// from. You only need to specify PreSignedUrl when you are performing cross-region
	// replication from an encrypted DB cluster.
	//
	// The pre-signed URL must be a valid request for the CreateDBCluster API action
	// that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted
	// DB cluster to be copied.
	//
	// The pre-signed URL request must contain the following parameter values:
	//
	//    * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
	//    the copy of the DB cluster in the destination AWS Region. This should
	//    refer to the same KMS key for both the CreateDBCluster action that is
	//    called in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the
	//    pre-signed URL.
	//
	//    * DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that Aurora Read Replica
	//    will be created in.
	//
	//    * ReplicationSourceIdentifier - The DB cluster identifier for the encrypted
	//    DB cluster to be copied. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
	//    Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are copying
	//    an encrypted DB cluster from the us-west-2 AWS Region, then your ReplicationSourceIdentifier
	//    would look like Example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster:aurora-cluster1.
	//
	// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see  Authenticating
	// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
	// and  Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
	PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`

	// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
	// backups are enabled using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see  Adjusting
	// the Preferred Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
	//
	//    * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	//    * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
	//
	//    * Must be at least 30 minutes.
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
	// Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
	// the time blocks available, see  Adjusting the Preferred Maintenance Window
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
	PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the source DB instance or DB cluster if
	// this DB cluster is created as a Read Replica.
	ReplicationSourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
	// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
	// have the same region as the source ARN.
	SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`

	// Specifies whether the DB cluster is encrypted.
	StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with this DB cluster.
	VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBClusterInput) GoString

func (s CreateDBClusterInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetAvailabilityZones

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetCharacterSetName

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetDatabaseName

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDatabaseName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetDestinationRegion

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetDestinationRegion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetEngineVersion

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetKmsKeyId

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetMasterUsername

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetMasterUsername(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreSignedUrl

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreSignedUrl(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetReplicationSourceIdentifier

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetReplicationSourceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetReplicationSourceIdentifier sets the ReplicationSourceIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetSourceRegion

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetSourceRegion(v string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetStorageEncrypted

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetTags

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetTags(v []*Tag) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDBClusterInput

SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.

func (CreateDBClusterInput) String

func (s CreateDBClusterInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterInput) Validate

func (s *CreateDBClusterInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBClusterOutput

type CreateDBClusterOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
	DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBClusterOutput) GoString

func (s CreateDBClusterOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster

SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.

func (CreateDBClusterOutput) String

func (s CreateDBClusterOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput

type CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
	//
	// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The DB cluster parameter group family name. A DB cluster parameter group
	// can be associated with one and only one DB cluster parameter group family,
	// and can be applied only to a DB cluster running a database engine and engine
	// version compatible with that DB cluster parameter group family.
	//
	// Aurora MySQL
	//
	// Example: aurora5.6, aurora-mysql5.7
	//
	// Aurora PostgreSQL
	//
	// Example: aurora-postgresql9.6
	//
	// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The description for the DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	// Description is a required field
	Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDescription

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput

type CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
	// action.
	DBClusterParameterGroup *DBClusterParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroup

SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.

func (CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput

type CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {

	// The identifier of the DB cluster to create a snapshot for. This parameter
	// is not case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
	//
	// Example: my-cluster1
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot. This parameter is stored as a
	// lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	//
	// Example: my-cluster1-snapshot1
	//
	// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The tags to be assigned to the DB cluster snapshot.
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString

func (s CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput

SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate

func (s *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput

type CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
	// action.
	DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot

SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.

func (CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBInstanceInput

type CreateDBInstanceInput struct {

	// The amount of storage (in gibibytes) to allocate for the DB instance.
	//
	// Type: Integer
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. Aurora cluster volumes automatically grow as the amount of
	// data in your database increases, though you are only charged for the space
	// that you use in an Aurora cluster volume.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
	//
	//    * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
	//
	//    * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
	//
	// PostgreSQL
	//
	// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
	//
	//    * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 5 to 3072.
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
	//
	//    * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2): Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1): Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Magnetic storage (standard): Must be an integer from 10 to 3072.
	//
	// SQL Server
	//
	// Constraints to the amount of storage for each storage type are the following:
	//
	//    * General Purpose (SSD) storage (gp2):
	//
	// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 16384.
	//
	// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 20 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Provisioned IOPS storage (io1):
	//
	// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 16384.
	//
	// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 100 to 16384.
	//
	//    * Magnetic storage (standard):
	//
	// Enterprise and Standard editions: Must be an integer from 200 to 1024.
	//
	// Web and Express editions: Must be an integer from 20 to 1024.
	AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Indicates that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
	// instance during the maintenance window.
	//
	// Default: true
	AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in. For information
	// on AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions and Availability Zones
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html).
	//
	// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
	// Region.
	//
	// Example: us-east-1d
	//
	// Constraint: The AvailabilityZone parameter can't be specified if the MultiAZ
	// parameter is set to true. The specified Availability Zone must be in the
	// same AWS Region as the current endpoint.
	AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`

	// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. Setting this
	// parameter to a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to
	// 0 disables automated backups.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The retention period for automated backups is managed by
	// the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// Default: 1
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be a value from 0 to 35
	//
	//    * Cannot be set to 0 if the DB instance is a source to Read Replicas
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// For supported engines, indicates that the DB instance should be associated
	// with the specified CharacterSet.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The character set is managed by the DB cluster. For more
	// information, see CreateDBCluster.
	CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`

	// True to copy all tags from the DB instance to snapshots of the DB instance,
	// and otherwise false. The default is false.
	CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The identifier of the DB cluster that the instance will belong to.
	//
	// For information on creating a DB cluster, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// Type: String
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
	// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
	// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
	// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// DBInstanceClass is a required field
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	//
	// Example: mydbinstance
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The meaning of this parameter differs according to the database engine you
	// use.
	//
	// Type: String
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
	// parameter is not specified, no database is created in the DB instance.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a word reserved by the specified database engine
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
	// parameter is not specified, no database is created in the DB instance.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a word reserved by the specified database engine
	//
	// PostgreSQL
	//
	// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. If this
	// parameter is not specified, the default "postgres" database is created in
	// the DB instance.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or underscores.
	//
	//    * Must begin with a letter or an underscore. Subsequent characters can
	//    be letters, underscores, or digits (0-9).
	//
	//    * Cannot be a word reserved by the specified database engine
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// The Oracle System ID (SID) of the created DB instance. If you specify null,
	// the default value ORCL is used. You can't specify the string NULL, or any
	// other reserved word, for DBName.
	//
	// Default: ORCL
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Cannot be longer than 8 characters
	//
	// SQL Server
	//
	// Not applicable. Must be null.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// The name of the database to create when the primary instance of the DB cluster
	// is created. If this parameter is not specified, no database is created in
	// the DB instance.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain 1 to 64 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a word reserved by the specified database engine
	DBName *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the DB parameter group to associate with this DB instance. If
	// this argument is omitted, the default DBParameterGroup for the specified
	// engine is used.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of DB security groups to associate with this DB instance.
	//
	// Default: The default DB security group for the database engine.
	DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`

	// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB instance.
	//
	// If there is no DB subnet group, then it is a non-VPC DB instance.
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Specify the Active Directory Domain to create the instance in.
	Domain *string `type:"string"`

	// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
	// Directory Service.
	DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`

	// The list of log types that need to be enabled for exporting to CloudWatch
	// Logs.
	EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines:
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. Mapping AWS IAM accounts to database accounts is managed
	// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
	EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the database engine to be used for this instance.
	//
	// Not every database engine is available for every AWS Region.
	//
	// Valid Values:
	//
	//    * aurora (for MySQL 5.6-compatible Aurora)
	//
	//    * aurora-mysql (for MySQL 5.7-compatible Aurora)
	//
	//    * aurora-postgresql
	//
	//    * mariadb
	//
	//    * mysql
	//
	//    * oracle-ee
	//
	//    * oracle-se2
	//
	//    * oracle-se1
	//
	//    * oracle-se
	//
	//    * postgres
	//
	//    * sqlserver-ee
	//
	//    * sqlserver-se
	//
	//    * sqlserver-ex
	//
	//    * sqlserver-web
	//
	// Engine is a required field
	Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The version number of the database engine to use.
	//
	// The following are the database engines and major and minor versions that
	// are available with Amazon RDS. Not every database engine is available for
	// every AWS Region.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The version number of the database engine to be used by the
	// DB instance is managed by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	//    * 10.2.12 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.2.11 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	// 10.1.31 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.1.26 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.1.23 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.1.19 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.1.14 (supported in all AWS Regions except us-east-2)
	//
	//    * 10.0.34 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.0.32 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.0.31 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.0.28 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.0.24 (supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 10.0.17 (supported in all AWS Regions except us-east-2, ca-central-1,
	//    eu-west-2)
	//
	// Microsoft SQL Server 2017
	//
	//    * 14.00.1000.169.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
	//
	// Microsoft SQL Server 2016
	//
	//    * 13.00.4451.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 13.00.4422.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 13.00.2164.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
	//
	// Microsoft SQL Server 2014
	//
	//    * 12.00.5546.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 12.00.5000.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 12.00.4422.0.v1 (supported for all editions except Enterprise Edition,
	//    and all AWS Regions except ca-central-1 and eu-west-2)
	//
	// Microsoft SQL Server 2012
	//
	//    * 11.00.6594.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 11.00.6020.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions)
	//
	//    * 11.00.5058.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
	//    us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
	//
	//    * 11.00.2100.60.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
	//    us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
	//
	// Microsoft SQL Server 2008 R2
	//
	//    * 10.50.6529.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
	//    us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
	//
	//    * 10.50.6000.34.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
	//    us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
	//
	//    * 10.50.2789.0.v1 (supported for all editions, and all AWS Regions except
	//    us-east-2, ca-central-1, and eu-west-2)
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	//    * 5.7.21 (supported in all AWS regions)
	//
	//    * 5.7.19 (supported in all AWS regions)
	//
	//    * 5.7.17 (supported in all AWS regions)
	//
	//    * 5.7.16 (supported in all AWS regions)
	//
	// 5.6.39(supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	// 5.6.37(supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	// 5.6.35(supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	// 5.6.34(supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	// 5.6.29(supported in all AWS Regions)
	//
	// 5.6.27
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
	// initially allocated for the DB instance. For information about valid Iops
	// values, see see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to Improve Performance
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS).
	//
	// Constraints: Must be a multiple between 1 and 50 of the storage amount for
	// the DB instance. Must also be an integer multiple of 1000. For example, if
	// the size of your DB instance is 500 GiB, then your Iops value can be 2000,
	// 3000, 4000, or 5000.
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB instance.
	//
	// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
	// key. If you are creating a DB instance with the same AWS account that owns
	// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB instance, then you can
	// use the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The KMS key identifier is managed by the DB cluster. For
	// more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
	// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
	// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
	// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// License model information for this DB instance.
	//
	// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// The password for the master user. The password can include any printable
	// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The password for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
	// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
	//
	// Microsoft SQL Server
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 30 characters.
	//
	// PostgreSQL
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
	MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// The name for the master user.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The name for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
	// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Required for MariaDB.
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
	//
	// Microsoft SQL Server
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Required for SQL Server.
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 128 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * The first character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Required for MySQL.
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Required for Oracle.
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 30 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
	//
	// PostgreSQL
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Required for PostgreSQL.
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 63 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
	MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`

	// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
	// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
	// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
	//
	// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
	// to a value other than 0.
	//
	// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
	MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
	// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
	// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to Setting Up and Enabling
	// Enhanced Monitoring (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.OS.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.Enabling).
	//
	// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
	// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
	MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment. You can't set the
	// AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ parameter is set to true.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates that the DB instance should be associated with the specified option
	// group.
	//
	// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
	// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
	// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
	// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
	// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
	PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	// Default: 3306
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// Type: Integer
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	// Default: 3306
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// Type: Integer
	//
	// PostgreSQL
	//
	// Default: 5432
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// Type: Integer
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// Default: 1521
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// SQL Server
	//
	// Default: 1433
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535 except for 1434, 3389, 47001, 49152, and 49152 through
	// 49156.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Default: 3306
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// Type: Integer
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
	// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter. For more
	// information, see The Backup Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.html#USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.BackupWindow).
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The daily time range for creating automated backups is managed
	// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see  Adjusting
	// the Preferred DB Instance Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow).
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
	//
	//    * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	//    * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
	//
	//    * Must be at least 30 minutes.
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// The time range each week during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
	// Coordinated Time (UTC). For more information, see Amazon RDS Maintenance
	// Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#Concepts.DBMaintenance).
	//
	// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week.
	//
	// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
	PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
	// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
	// more information, see  Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Managing.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance).
	//
	// Default: 1
	//
	// Valid Values: 0 - 15
	PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
	// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
	// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
	// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
	//
	// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
	// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
	//
	//    * Default VPC: true
	//
	//    * VPC: false
	//
	// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
	// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
	PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies whether the DB instance is encrypted.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The encryption for DB instances is managed by the DB cluster.
	// For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// Default: false
	StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
	//
	// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
	//
	// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
	//
	// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
	TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
	// device.
	TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// The time zone of the DB instance. The time zone parameter is currently supported
	// only by Microsoft SQL Server (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_SQLServer.html#SQLServer.Concepts.General.TimeZone).
	Timezone *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with this DB instance.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The associated list of EC2 VPC security groups is managed
	// by the DB cluster. For more information, see CreateDBCluster.
	//
	// Default: The default EC2 VPC security group for the DB subnet group's VPC.
	VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBInstanceInput) GoString

func (s CreateDBInstanceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAllocatedStorage

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAvailabilityZone

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetCharacterSetName

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceClass

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBName

SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBSecurityGroups

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDomain

SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEngineVersion

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetIops

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetKmsKeyId

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetLicenseModel

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUserPassword

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUsername

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUsername(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringInterval

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPromotionTier

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPubliclyAccessible

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetStorageEncrypted

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetStorageType

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetStorageType(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialArn

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetTimezone

SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceInput

SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.

func (CreateDBInstanceInput) String

func (s CreateDBInstanceInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBInstanceInput) Validate

func (s *CreateDBInstanceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBInstanceOutput

type CreateDBInstanceOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBInstanceOutput) GoString

func (s CreateDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (CreateDBInstanceOutput) String

func (s CreateDBInstanceOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput

type CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput struct {

	// Indicates that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to the Read
	// Replica during the maintenance window.
	//
	// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance
	AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The Amazon EC2 Availability Zone that the Read Replica is created in.
	//
	// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
	// Region.
	//
	// Example: us-east-1d
	AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`

	// True to copy all tags from the Read Replica to snapshots of the Read Replica,
	// and otherwise false. The default is false.
	CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The compute and memory capacity of the Read Replica, for example, db.m4.large.
	// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
	// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
	// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB instance identifier of the Read Replica. This identifier is the unique
	// key that identifies a DB instance. This parameter is stored as a lowercase
	// string.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Specifies a DB subnet group for the DB instance. The new DB instance is created
	// in the VPC associated with the DB subnet group. If no DB subnet group is
	// specified, then the new DB instance is not created in a VPC.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Can only be specified if the source DB instance identifier specifies
	//    a DB instance in another AWS Region.
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
	//
	//    * The specified DB subnet group must be in the same AWS Region in which
	//    the operation is running.
	//
	//    * All Read Replicas in one AWS Region that are created from the same source
	//    DB instance must either:>
	//
	// Specify DB subnet groups from the same VPC. All these Read Replicas are created
	//    in the same VPC.
	//
	// Not specify a DB subnet group. All these Read Replicas are created outside
	//    of any VPC.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// DestinationRegion is used for presigning the request to a given region.
	DestinationRegion *string `type:"string"`

	// The list of logs that the new DB instance is to export to CloudWatch Logs.
	EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
	//
	//    * Aurora 5.6 or higher.
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// True to enable Performance Insights for the read replica, and otherwise false.
	EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
	// initially allocated for the DB instance.
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The AWS KMS key ID for an encrypted Read Replica. The KMS key ID is the Amazon
	// Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the KMS key alias for the KMS
	// encryption key.
	//
	// If you specify this parameter when you create a Read Replica from an unencrypted
	// DB instance, the Read Replica is encrypted.
	//
	// If you create an encrypted Read Replica in the same AWS Region as the source
	// DB instance, then you do not have to specify a value for this parameter.
	// The Read Replica is encrypted with the same KMS key as the source DB instance.
	//
	// If you create an encrypted Read Replica in a different AWS Region, then you
	// must specify a KMS key for the destination AWS Region. KMS encryption keys
	// are specific to the AWS Region that they are created in, and you can't use
	// encryption keys from one AWS Region in another AWS Region.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
	// are collected for the Read Replica. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
	// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
	//
	// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
	// to a value other than 0.
	//
	// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
	MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
	// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
	// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to To create an IAM role
	// for Amazon RDS Enhanced Monitoring (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.IAMRole).
	//
	// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
	// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
	MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether the Read Replica is in a Multi-AZ deployment.
	//
	// You can create a Read Replica as a Multi-AZ DB instance. RDS creates a standby
	// of your replica in another Availability Zone for failover support for the
	// replica. Creating your Read Replica as a Multi-AZ DB instance is independent
	// of whether the source database is a Multi-AZ DB instance.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The option group the DB instance is associated with. If omitted, the default
	// option group for the engine specified is used.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
	// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
	// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
	PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number that the DB instance uses for connections.
	//
	// Default: Inherits from the source DB instance
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
	// API action in the source AWS Region that contains the source DB instance.
	//
	// You must specify this parameter when you create an encrypted Read Replica
	// from another AWS Region by using the Amazon RDS API. You can specify the
	// --source-region option instead of this parameter when you create an encrypted
	// Read Replica from another AWS Region by using the AWS CLI.
	//
	// The presigned URL must be a valid request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
	// API action that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the
	// encrypted source DB instance. The presigned URL request must contain the
	// following parameter values:
	//
	//    * DestinationRegion - The AWS Region that the encrypted Read Replica is
	//    created in. This AWS Region is the same one where the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
	//    action is called that contains this presigned URL.
	//
	// For example, if you create an encrypted DB instance in the us-west-1 AWS
	//    Region, from a source DB instance in the us-east-2 AWS Region, then you
	//    call the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica action in the us-east-1 AWS Region
	//    and provide a presigned URL that contains a call to the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica
	//    action in the us-west-2 AWS Region. For this example, the DestinationRegion
	//    in the presigned URL must be set to the us-east-1 AWS Region.
	//
	//    * KmsKeyId - The AWS KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt
	//    the Read Replica in the destination AWS Region. This is the same identifier
	//    for both the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica action that is called in the
	//    destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the presigned URL.
	//
	//
	//    * SourceDBInstanceIdentifier - The DB instance identifier for the encrypted
	//    DB instance to be replicated. This identifier must be in the Amazon Resource
	//    Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For example, if you are creating
	//    an encrypted Read Replica from a DB instance in the us-west-2 AWS Region,
	//    then your SourceDBInstanceIdentifier looks like the following example:
	//    arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:instance:mysql-instance1-20161115.
	//
	//
	// To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating
	// Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
	// and Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).
	PreSignedUrl *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
	// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
	// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
	// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
	//
	// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
	// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
	//
	//    * Default VPC:true
	//
	//    * VPC:false
	//
	// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
	// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
	PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The identifier of the DB instance that will act as the source for the Read
	// Replica. Each DB instance can have up to five Read Replicas.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be the identifier of an existing MySQL, MariaDB, or PostgreSQL
	//    DB instance.
	//
	//    * Can specify a DB instance that is a MySQL Read Replica only if the source
	//    is running MySQL 5.6.
	//
	//    * Can specify a DB instance that is a PostgreSQL DB instance only if the
	//    source is running PostgreSQL 9.3.5 or later (9.4.7 and higher for cross-region
	//    replication).
	//
	//    * The specified DB instance must have automatic backups enabled, its backup
	//    retention period must be greater than 0.
	//
	//    * If the source DB instance is in the same AWS Region as the Read Replica,
	//    specify a valid DB instance identifier.
	//
	//    * If the source DB instance is in a different AWS Region than the Read
	//    Replica, specify a valid DB instance ARN. For more information, go to
	//     Constructing a Amazon RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
	//
	// SourceDBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	SourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// SourceRegion is the source region where the resource exists. This is not
	// sent over the wire and is only used for presigning. This value should always
	// have the same region as the source ARN.
	SourceRegion *string `type:"string" ignore:"true"`

	// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the Read Replica.
	//
	// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
	//
	// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
	//
	// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade

SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetAvailabilityZone

SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot

SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetDestinationRegion

SetDestinationRegion sets the DestinationRegion field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports

func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput

SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights

func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput

SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetIops

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetKmsKeyId

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMonitoringInterval

SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn

SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetOptionGroupName

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId

func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput

SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPreSignedUrl

SetPreSignedUrl sets the PreSignedUrl field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetPubliclyAccessible

SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput

SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the SourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetSourceRegion

SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetStorageType

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput

type CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBParameterGroupInput

type CreateDBParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The DB parameter group family name. A DB parameter group can be associated
	// with one and only one DB parameter group family, and can be applied only
	// to a DB instance running a database engine and engine version compatible
	// with that DB parameter group family.
	//
	// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the DB parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The description for the DB parameter group.
	//
	// Description is a required field
	Description *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBParameterGroupInput) GoString

func (s CreateDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *CreateDBParameterGroupInput

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetDescription

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (*CreateDBParameterGroupInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateDBParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBParameterGroupInput) Validate

func (s *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBParameterGroupOutput

type CreateDBParameterGroupOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups
	// action.
	DBParameterGroup *DBParameterGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString

func (s CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) SetDBParameterGroup

SetDBParameterGroup sets the DBParameterGroup field's value.

func (CreateDBParameterGroupOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBSecurityGroupInput

type CreateDBSecurityGroupInput struct {

	// The description for the DB security group.
	//
	// DBSecurityGroupDescription is a required field
	DBSecurityGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name for the DB security group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	//    * Must not be "Default"
	//
	// Example: mysecuritygroup
	//
	// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
	DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) GoString

func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupDescription

func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupDescription(v string) *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput

SetDBSecurityGroupDescription sets the DBSecurityGroupDescription field's value.

func (*CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName

func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput

SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) Validate

func (s *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput

type CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput struct {

	// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
	// action.
	DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) GoString

func (s CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup

SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.

func (CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBSnapshotInput

type CreateDBSnapshotInput struct {

	// The identifier of the DB instance that you want to create the snapshot of.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The identifier for the DB snapshot.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Cannot be null, empty, or blank
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: my-snapshot-id
	//
	// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBSnapshotInput) GoString

func (s CreateDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBSnapshotInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *CreateDBSnapshotInput

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*CreateDBSnapshotInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateDBSnapshotInput) String

func (s CreateDBSnapshotInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSnapshotInput) Validate

func (s *CreateDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBSnapshotOutput

type CreateDBSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
	DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBSnapshotOutput) GoString

func (s CreateDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot

SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.

func (CreateDBSnapshotOutput) String

func (s CreateDBSnapshotOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type CreateDBSubnetGroupInput

type CreateDBSubnetGroupInput struct {

	// The description for the DB subnet group.
	//
	// DBSubnetGroupDescription is a required field
	DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name for the DB subnet group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain no more than 255 letters, numbers, periods, underscores,
	// spaces, or hyphens. Must not be default.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	//
	// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The EC2 Subnet IDs for the DB subnet group.
	//
	// SubnetIds is a required field
	SubnetIds []*string `locationNameList:"SubnetIdentifier" type:"list" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString

func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription

func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput

SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.

func (*CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetSubnetIds

SetSubnetIds sets the SubnetIds field's value.

func (*CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) String

func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate

func (s *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput

type CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
	// action.
	DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString

func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) SetDBSubnetGroup

SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.

func (CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) String

func (s CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type CreateEventSubscriptionInput

type CreateEventSubscriptionInput struct {

	// A Boolean value; set to true to activate the subscription, set to false to
	// create the subscription but not active it.
	Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A list of event categories for a SourceType that you want to subscribe to.
	// You can see a list of the categories for a given SourceType in the Events
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
	// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories
	// action.
	EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SNS topic created for event notification.
	// The ARN is created by Amazon SNS when you create a topic and subscribe to
	// it.
	//
	// SnsTopicArn is a required field
	SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The list of identifiers of the event sources for which events are returned.
	// If not specified, then all sources are included in the response. An identifier
	// must begin with a letter and must contain only ASCII letters, digits, and
	// hyphens; it can't end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If SourceIds are supplied, SourceType must also be provided.
	//
	//    * If the source type is a DB instance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must
	//    be supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is a DB security group, a DBSecurityGroupName must
	//    be supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is a DB parameter group, a DBParameterGroupName must
	//    be supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is a DB snapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be
	//    supplied.
	SourceIds []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"`

	// The type of source that is generating the events. For example, if you want
	// to be notified of events generated by a DB instance, you would set this parameter
	// to db-instance. if this value is not specified, all events are returned.
	//
	// Valid values: db-instance | db-cluster | db-parameter-group | db-security-group
	// | db-snapshot | db-cluster-snapshot
	SourceType *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the subscription.
	//
	// Constraints: The name must be less than 255 characters.
	//
	// SubscriptionName is a required field
	SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateEventSubscriptionInput) GoString

func (s CreateEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetEnabled

SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetEventCategories

SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSnsTopicArn

SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIds

SetSourceIds sets the SourceIds field's value.

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceType

SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName

SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateEventSubscriptionInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionInput) Validate

func (s *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateEventSubscriptionOutput

type CreateEventSubscriptionOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
	// action.
	EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription

SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.

func (CreateEventSubscriptionOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type CreateOptionGroupInput

type CreateOptionGroupInput struct {

	// Specifies the name of the engine that this option group should be associated
	// with.
	//
	// EngineName is a required field
	EngineName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Specifies the major version of the engine that this option group should be
	// associated with.
	//
	// MajorEngineVersion is a required field
	MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The description of the option group.
	//
	// OptionGroupDescription is a required field
	OptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Specifies the name of the option group to be created.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: myoptiongroup
	//
	// OptionGroupName is a required field
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateOptionGroupInput) GoString

func (s CreateOptionGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateOptionGroupInput) SetEngineName

SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.

func (*CreateOptionGroupInput) SetMajorEngineVersion

func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput

SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.

func (*CreateOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupDescription

func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput

SetOptionGroupDescription sets the OptionGroupDescription field's value.

func (*CreateOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *CreateOptionGroupInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*CreateOptionGroupInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (CreateOptionGroupInput) String

func (s CreateOptionGroupInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*CreateOptionGroupInput) Validate

func (s *CreateOptionGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type CreateOptionGroupOutput

type CreateOptionGroupOutput struct {
	OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (CreateOptionGroupOutput) GoString

func (s CreateOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*CreateOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup

SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.

func (CreateOptionGroupOutput) String

func (s CreateOptionGroupOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBCluster

type DBCluster struct {

	// For all database engines except Amazon Aurora, AllocatedStorage specifies
	// the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB). For Aurora, AllocatedStorage
	// always returns 1, because Aurora DB cluster storage size is not fixed, but
	// instead automatically adjusts as needed.
	AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Provides a list of the AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) roles that
	// are associated with the DB cluster. IAM roles that are associated with a
	// DB cluster grant permission for the DB cluster to access other AWS services
	// on your behalf.
	AssociatedRoles []*DBClusterRole `locationNameList:"DBClusterRole" type:"list"`

	// Provides the list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster
	// can be created in.
	AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`

	// Specifies the number of days for which automatic DB snapshots are retained.
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// If present, specifies the name of the character set that this cluster is
	// associated with.
	CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`

	// Identifies the clone group to which the DB cluster is associated.
	CloneGroupId *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the time when the DB cluster was created, in Universal Coordinated
	// Time (UTC).
	ClusterCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster.
	DBClusterArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains a user-supplied DB cluster identifier. This identifier is the unique
	// key that identifies a DB cluster.
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the list of instances that make up the DB cluster.
	DBClusterMembers []*DBClusterMember `locationNameList:"DBClusterMember" type:"list"`

	// Provides the list of option group memberships for this DB cluster.
	DBClusterOptionGroupMemberships []*DBClusterOptionGroupStatus `locationNameList:"DBClusterOptionGroup" type:"list"`

	// Specifies the name of the DB cluster parameter group for the DB cluster.
	DBClusterParameterGroup *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies information on the subnet group associated with the DB cluster,
	// including the name, description, and subnets in the subnet group.
	DBSubnetGroup *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains the name of the initial database of this DB cluster that was provided
	// at create time, if one was specified when the DB cluster was created. This
	// same name is returned for the life of the DB cluster.
	DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS Region-unique, immutable identifier for the DB cluster. This identifier
	// is found in AWS CloudTrail log entries whenever the AWS KMS key for the DB
	// cluster is accessed.
	DbClusterResourceId *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the earliest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
	// restore.
	EarliestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Specifies the connection endpoint for the primary instance of the DB cluster.
	Endpoint *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the name of the database engine to be used for this DB cluster.
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates the database engine version.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the ID that Amazon Route 53 assigns when you create a hosted zone.
	HostedZoneId *string `type:"string"`

	// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
	// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
	IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
	// DB cluster.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the latest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
	// restore.
	LatestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Contains the master username for the DB cluster.
	MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether the DB cluster has instances in multiple Availability Zones.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the progress of the operation as a percentage.
	PercentProgress *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the port that the database engine is listening on.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the daily time range during which automated backups are created
	// if automated backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod.
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur,
	// in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains one or more identifiers of the Read Replicas associated with this
	// DB cluster.
	ReadReplicaIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaIdentifier" type:"list"`

	// The reader endpoint for the DB cluster. The reader endpoint for a DB cluster
	// load-balances connections across the Aurora Replicas that are available in
	// a DB cluster. As clients request new connections to the reader endpoint,
	// Aurora distributes the connection requests among the Aurora Replicas in the
	// DB cluster. This functionality can help balance your read workload across
	// multiple Aurora Replicas in your DB cluster.
	//
	// If a failover occurs, and the Aurora Replica that you are connected to is
	// promoted to be the primary instance, your connection is dropped. To continue
	// sending your read workload to other Aurora Replicas in the cluster, you can
	// then reconnect to the reader endpoint.
	ReaderEndpoint *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains the identifier of the source DB cluster if this DB cluster is a
	// Read Replica.
	ReplicationSourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the current state of this DB cluster.
	Status *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether the DB cluster is encrypted.
	StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Provides a list of VPC security groups that the DB cluster belongs to.
	VpcSecurityGroups []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.

func (DBCluster) GoString

func (s DBCluster) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBCluster) SetAllocatedStorage

func (s *DBCluster) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBCluster

SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetAssociatedRoles

func (s *DBCluster) SetAssociatedRoles(v []*DBClusterRole) *DBCluster

SetAssociatedRoles sets the AssociatedRoles field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetAvailabilityZones

func (s *DBCluster) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *DBCluster

SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *DBCluster) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *DBCluster

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetCharacterSetName

func (s *DBCluster) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *DBCluster

SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetCloneGroupId

func (s *DBCluster) SetCloneGroupId(v string) *DBCluster

SetCloneGroupId sets the CloneGroupId field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetClusterCreateTime

func (s *DBCluster) SetClusterCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster

SetClusterCreateTime sets the ClusterCreateTime field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetDBClusterArn

func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterArn(v string) *DBCluster

SetDBClusterArn sets the DBClusterArn field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBCluster

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetDBClusterMembers

func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterMembers(v []*DBClusterMember) *DBCluster

SetDBClusterMembers sets the DBClusterMembers field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetDBClusterOptionGroupMemberships

func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterOptionGroupMemberships(v []*DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) *DBCluster

SetDBClusterOptionGroupMemberships sets the DBClusterOptionGroupMemberships field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetDBClusterParameterGroup

func (s *DBCluster) SetDBClusterParameterGroup(v string) *DBCluster

SetDBClusterParameterGroup sets the DBClusterParameterGroup field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetDBSubnetGroup

func (s *DBCluster) SetDBSubnetGroup(v string) *DBCluster

SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetDatabaseName

func (s *DBCluster) SetDatabaseName(v string) *DBCluster

SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetDbClusterResourceId

func (s *DBCluster) SetDbClusterResourceId(v string) *DBCluster

SetDbClusterResourceId sets the DbClusterResourceId field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetEarliestRestorableTime

func (s *DBCluster) SetEarliestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster

SetEarliestRestorableTime sets the EarliestRestorableTime field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetEndpoint

func (s *DBCluster) SetEndpoint(v string) *DBCluster

SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetEngine

func (s *DBCluster) SetEngine(v string) *DBCluster

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetEngineVersion

func (s *DBCluster) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBCluster

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetHostedZoneId

func (s *DBCluster) SetHostedZoneId(v string) *DBCluster

SetHostedZoneId sets the HostedZoneId field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled

func (s *DBCluster) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBCluster

SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetKmsKeyId

func (s *DBCluster) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBCluster

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetLatestRestorableTime

func (s *DBCluster) SetLatestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBCluster

SetLatestRestorableTime sets the LatestRestorableTime field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetMasterUsername

func (s *DBCluster) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBCluster

SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetMultiAZ

func (s *DBCluster) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DBCluster

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetPercentProgress

func (s *DBCluster) SetPercentProgress(v string) *DBCluster

SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetPort

func (s *DBCluster) SetPort(v int64) *DBCluster

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *DBCluster) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *DBCluster

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow

func (s *DBCluster) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *DBCluster

SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetReadReplicaIdentifiers

func (s *DBCluster) SetReadReplicaIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBCluster

SetReadReplicaIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaIdentifiers field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetReaderEndpoint

func (s *DBCluster) SetReaderEndpoint(v string) *DBCluster

SetReaderEndpoint sets the ReaderEndpoint field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetReplicationSourceIdentifier

func (s *DBCluster) SetReplicationSourceIdentifier(v string) *DBCluster

SetReplicationSourceIdentifier sets the ReplicationSourceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetStatus

func (s *DBCluster) SetStatus(v string) *DBCluster

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetStorageEncrypted

func (s *DBCluster) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBCluster

SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.

func (*DBCluster) SetVpcSecurityGroups

func (s *DBCluster) SetVpcSecurityGroups(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *DBCluster

SetVpcSecurityGroups sets the VpcSecurityGroups field's value.

func (DBCluster) String

func (s DBCluster) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBClusterMember

type DBClusterMember struct {

	// Specifies the status of the DB cluster parameter group for this member of
	// the DB cluster.
	DBClusterParameterGroupStatus *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the instance identifier for this member of the DB cluster.
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Value that is true if the cluster member is the primary instance for the
	// DB cluster and false otherwise.
	IsClusterWriter *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
	// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
	// more information, see  Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Managing.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance).
	PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains information about an instance that is part of a DB cluster.

func (DBClusterMember) GoString

func (s DBClusterMember) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBClusterMember) SetDBClusterParameterGroupStatus

func (s *DBClusterMember) SetDBClusterParameterGroupStatus(v string) *DBClusterMember

SetDBClusterParameterGroupStatus sets the DBClusterParameterGroupStatus field's value.

func (*DBClusterMember) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *DBClusterMember) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterMember

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBClusterMember) SetIsClusterWriter

func (s *DBClusterMember) SetIsClusterWriter(v bool) *DBClusterMember

SetIsClusterWriter sets the IsClusterWriter field's value.

func (*DBClusterMember) SetPromotionTier

func (s *DBClusterMember) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *DBClusterMember

SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.

func (DBClusterMember) String

func (s DBClusterMember) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBClusterOptionGroupStatus

type DBClusterOptionGroupStatus struct {

	// Specifies the name of the DB cluster option group.
	DBClusterOptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the status of the DB cluster option group.
	Status *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains status information for a DB cluster option group.

func (DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) GoString

func (s DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) SetDBClusterOptionGroupName

func (s *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) SetDBClusterOptionGroupName(v string) *DBClusterOptionGroupStatus

SetDBClusterOptionGroupName sets the DBClusterOptionGroupName field's value.

func (*DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) SetStatus

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (DBClusterOptionGroupStatus) String

String returns the string representation

type DBClusterParameterGroup

type DBClusterParameterGroup struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster parameter group.
	DBClusterParameterGroupArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the name of the DB cluster parameter group.
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the name of the DB parameter group family that this DB cluster parameter
	// group is compatible with.
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the customer-specified description for this DB cluster parameter
	// group.
	Description *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster parameter group.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups action.

func (DBClusterParameterGroup) GoString

func (s DBClusterParameterGroup) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBClusterParameterGroupArn

func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBClusterParameterGroupArn(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup

SetDBClusterParameterGroupArn sets the DBClusterParameterGroupArn field's value.

func (*DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

func (s *DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBClusterParameterGroup

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*DBClusterParameterGroup) SetDescription

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (DBClusterParameterGroup) String

func (s DBClusterParameterGroup) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage

type DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 255 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage) String

String returns the string representation

type DBClusterRole

type DBClusterRole struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role that is associated with the
	// DB cluster.
	RoleArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Describes the state of association between the IAM role and the DB cluster.
	// The Status property returns one of the following values:
	//
	//    * ACTIVE - the IAM role ARN is associated with the DB cluster and can
	//    be used to access other AWS services on your behalf.
	//
	//    * PENDING - the IAM role ARN is being associated with the DB cluster.
	//
	//    * INVALID - the IAM role ARN is associated with the DB cluster, but the
	//    DB cluster is unable to assume the IAM role in order to access other AWS
	//    services on your behalf.
	Status *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Describes an AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role that is associated with a DB cluster.

func (DBClusterRole) GoString

func (s DBClusterRole) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBClusterRole) SetRoleArn

func (s *DBClusterRole) SetRoleArn(v string) *DBClusterRole

SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.

func (*DBClusterRole) SetStatus

func (s *DBClusterRole) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterRole

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (DBClusterRole) String

func (s DBClusterRole) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBClusterSnapshot

type DBClusterSnapshot struct {

	// Specifies the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB).
	AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Provides the list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the DB cluster
	// snapshot can be restored in.
	AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`

	// Specifies the time when the DB cluster was created, in Universal Coordinated
	// Time (UTC).
	ClusterCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Specifies the DB cluster identifier of the DB cluster that this DB cluster
	// snapshot was created from.
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB cluster snapshot.
	DBClusterSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the identifier for the DB cluster snapshot.
	DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the name of the database engine.
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the version of the database engine for this DB cluster snapshot.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
	// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
	IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
	// DB cluster snapshot.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the license model information for this DB cluster snapshot.
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the master username for the DB cluster snapshot.
	MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the percentage of the estimated data that has been transferred.
	PercentProgress *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the port that the DB cluster was listening on at the time of the
	// snapshot.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Provides the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated Time
	// (UTC).
	SnapshotCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Provides the type of the DB cluster snapshot.
	SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`

	// If the DB cluster snapshot was copied from a source DB cluster snapshot,
	// the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the source DB cluster snapshot, otherwise,
	// a null value.
	SourceDBClusterSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the status of this DB cluster snapshot.
	Status *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether the DB cluster snapshot is encrypted.
	StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Provides the VPC ID associated with the DB cluster snapshot.
	VpcId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots action.

func (DBClusterSnapshot) GoString

func (s DBClusterSnapshot) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetAllocatedStorage

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetAvailabilityZones

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetClusterCreateTime

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetClusterCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetClusterCreateTime sets the ClusterCreateTime field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterSnapshotArn

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterSnapshotArn(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetDBClusterSnapshotArn sets the DBClusterSnapshotArn field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetEngine

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetEngine(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetEngineVersion

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetKmsKeyId

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetLicenseModel

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetMasterUsername

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetPercentProgress

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetPercentProgress(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetPort

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetPort(v int64) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetSnapshotCreateTime sets the SnapshotCreateTime field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetSnapshotType

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotArn

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotArn(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetSourceDBClusterSnapshotArn sets the SourceDBClusterSnapshotArn field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetStatus

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetStatus(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetStorageEncrypted

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshot) SetVpcId

func (s *DBClusterSnapshot) SetVpcId(v string) *DBClusterSnapshot

SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.

func (DBClusterSnapshot) String

func (s DBClusterSnapshot) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBClusterSnapshotAttribute

type DBClusterSnapshotAttribute struct {

	// The name of the manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.
	//
	// The attribute named restore refers to the list of AWS accounts that have
	// permission to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information,
	// see the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
	AttributeName *string `type:"string"`

	// The value(s) for the manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.
	//
	// If the AttributeName field is set to restore, then this element returns a
	// list of IDs of the AWS accounts that are authorized to copy or restore the
	// manual DB cluster snapshot. If a value of all is in the list, then the manual
	// DB cluster snapshot is public and available for any AWS account to copy or
	// restore.
	AttributeValues []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the name and values of a manual DB cluster snapshot attribute.

Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.

func (DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) GoString

func (s DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeName

SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeValues

func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeValues(v []*string) *DBClusterSnapshotAttribute

SetAttributeValues sets the AttributeValues field's value.

func (DBClusterSnapshotAttribute) String

String returns the string representation

type DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult

type DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult struct {

	// The list of attributes and values for the manual DB cluster snapshot.
	DBClusterSnapshotAttributes []*DBClusterSnapshotAttribute `locationNameList:"DBClusterSnapshotAttribute" type:"list"`

	// The identifier of the manual DB cluster snapshot that the attributes apply
	// to.
	DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes API action.

Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.

func (DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributes

SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributes sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributes field's value.

func (*DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult

SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult) String

String returns the string representation

type DBEngineVersion

type DBEngineVersion struct {

	// The description of the database engine.
	DBEngineDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The description of the database engine version.
	DBEngineVersionDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the DB parameter group family for the database engine.
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`

	// The default character set for new instances of this engine version, if the
	// CharacterSetName parameter of the CreateDBInstance API is not specified.
	DefaultCharacterSet *CharacterSet `type:"structure"`

	// The name of the database engine.
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// The version number of the database engine.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The types of logs that the database engine has available for export to CloudWatch
	// Logs.
	ExportableLogTypes []*string `type:"list"`

	// A list of the character sets supported by this engine for the CharacterSetName
	// parameter of the CreateDBInstance action.
	SupportedCharacterSets []*CharacterSet `locationNameList:"CharacterSet" type:"list"`

	// A list of the time zones supported by this engine for the Timezone parameter
	// of the CreateDBInstance action.
	SupportedTimezones []*Timezone `locationNameList:"Timezone" type:"list"`

	// A value that indicates whether the engine version supports exporting the
	// log types specified by ExportableLogTypes to CloudWatch Logs.
	SupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates whether the database engine version supports read replicas.
	SupportsReadReplica *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A list of engine versions that this database engine version can be upgraded
	// to.
	ValidUpgradeTarget []*UpgradeTarget `locationNameList:"UpgradeTarget" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the action DescribeDBEngineVersions.

func (DBEngineVersion) GoString

func (s DBEngineVersion) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetDBEngineDescription

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBEngineDescription(v string) *DBEngineVersion

SetDBEngineDescription sets the DBEngineDescription field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetDBEngineVersionDescription

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBEngineVersionDescription(v string) *DBEngineVersion

SetDBEngineVersionDescription sets the DBEngineVersionDescription field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBEngineVersion

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetDefaultCharacterSet

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetDefaultCharacterSet(v *CharacterSet) *DBEngineVersion

SetDefaultCharacterSet sets the DefaultCharacterSet field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetEngine

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetEngine(v string) *DBEngineVersion

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetEngineVersion

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBEngineVersion

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetExportableLogTypes

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetExportableLogTypes(v []*string) *DBEngineVersion

SetExportableLogTypes sets the ExportableLogTypes field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedCharacterSets

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedCharacterSets(v []*CharacterSet) *DBEngineVersion

SetSupportedCharacterSets sets the SupportedCharacterSets field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedTimezones

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportedTimezones(v []*Timezone) *DBEngineVersion

SetSupportedTimezones sets the SupportedTimezones field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetSupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs(v bool) *DBEngineVersion

SetSupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs sets the SupportsLogExportsToCloudwatchLogs field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetSupportsReadReplica

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetSupportsReadReplica(v bool) *DBEngineVersion

SetSupportsReadReplica sets the SupportsReadReplica field's value.

func (*DBEngineVersion) SetValidUpgradeTarget

func (s *DBEngineVersion) SetValidUpgradeTarget(v []*UpgradeTarget) *DBEngineVersion

SetValidUpgradeTarget sets the ValidUpgradeTarget field's value.

func (DBEngineVersion) String

func (s DBEngineVersion) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBInstance

type DBInstance struct {

	// Specifies the allocated storage size specified in gibibytes.
	AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Indicates that minor version patches are applied automatically.
	AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the name of the Availability Zone the DB instance is located in.
	AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the number of days for which automatic DB snapshots are retained.
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The identifier of the CA certificate for this DB instance.
	CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// If present, specifies the name of the character set that this instance is
	// associated with.
	CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether tags are copied from the DB instance to snapshots of the
	// DB instance.
	CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// If the DB instance is a member of a DB cluster, contains the name of the
	// DB cluster that the DB instance is a member of.
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB instance.
	DBInstanceArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains the name of the compute and memory capacity class of the DB instance.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains a user-supplied database identifier. This identifier is the unique
	// key that identifies a DB instance.
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the current state of this database.
	DBInstanceStatus *string `type:"string"`

	// The meaning of this parameter differs according to the database engine you
	// use. For example, this value returns MySQL, MariaDB, or PostgreSQL information
	// when returning values from CreateDBInstanceReadReplica since Read Replicas
	// are only supported for these engines.
	//
	// MySQL, MariaDB, SQL Server, PostgreSQL
	//
	// Contains the name of the initial database of this instance that was provided
	// at create time, if one was specified when the DB instance was created. This
	// same name is returned for the life of the DB instance.
	//
	// Type: String
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// Contains the Oracle System ID (SID) of the created DB instance. Not shown
	// when the returned parameters do not apply to an Oracle DB instance.
	DBName *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the list of DB parameter groups applied to this DB instance.
	DBParameterGroups []*DBParameterGroupStatus `locationNameList:"DBParameterGroup" type:"list"`

	// Provides List of DB security group elements containing only DBSecurityGroup.Name
	// and DBSecurityGroup.Status subelements.
	DBSecurityGroups []*DBSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`

	// Specifies information on the subnet group associated with the DB instance,
	// including the name, description, and subnets in the subnet group.
	DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`

	// Specifies the port that the DB instance listens on. If the DB instance is
	// part of a DB cluster, this can be a different port than the DB cluster port.
	DbInstancePort *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The AWS Region-unique, immutable identifier for the DB instance. This identifier
	// is found in AWS CloudTrail log entries whenever the AWS KMS key for the DB
	// instance is accessed.
	DbiResourceId *string `type:"string"`

	// The Active Directory Domain membership records associated with the DB instance.
	DomainMemberships []*DomainMembership `locationNameList:"DomainMembership" type:"list"`

	// A list of log types that this DB instance is configured to export to CloudWatch
	// Logs.
	EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`

	// Specifies the connection endpoint.
	Endpoint *Endpoint `type:"structure"`

	// Provides the name of the database engine to be used for this DB instance.
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates the database engine version.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the Amazon CloudWatch Logs log stream that
	// receives the Enhanced Monitoring metrics data for the DB instance.
	EnhancedMonitoringResourceArn *string `type:"string"`

	// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
	// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
	//
	// IAM database authentication can be enabled for the following database engines
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
	//
	//    * Aurora 5.6 or higher. To enable IAM database authentication for Aurora,
	//    see DBCluster Type.
	IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Provides the date and time the DB instance was created.
	InstanceCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Specifies the Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value.
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// If StorageEncrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted
	// DB instance.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the latest time to which a database can be restored with point-in-time
	// restore.
	LatestRestorableTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// License model information for this DB instance.
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains the master username for the DB instance.
	MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`

	// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
	// are collected for the DB instance.
	MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send Enhanced Monitoring metrics
	// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs.
	MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Provides the list of option group memberships for this DB instance.
	OptionGroupMemberships []*OptionGroupMembership `locationNameList:"OptionGroupMembership" type:"list"`

	// Specifies that changes to the DB instance are pending. This element is only
	// included when changes are pending. Specific changes are identified by subelements.
	PendingModifiedValues *PendingModifiedValues `type:"structure"`

	// True if Performance Insights is enabled for the DB instance, and otherwise
	// false.
	PerformanceInsightsEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
	// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
	// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
	PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the daily time range during which automated backups are created
	// if automated backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod.
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur,
	// in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
	// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
	// more information, see  Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Managing.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance).
	PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
	// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
	// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
	// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
	//
	// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
	// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
	//
	//    * Default VPC:true
	//
	//    * VPC:false
	//
	// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
	// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
	PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Contains one or more identifiers of Aurora DB clusters that are Read Replicas
	// of this DB instance.
	ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifier" type:"list"`

	// Contains one or more identifiers of the Read Replicas associated with this
	// DB instance.
	ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers []*string `locationNameList:"ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifier" type:"list"`

	// Contains the identifier of the source DB instance if this DB instance is
	// a Read Replica.
	ReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// If present, specifies the name of the secondary Availability Zone for a DB
	// instance with multi-AZ support.
	SecondaryAvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`

	// The status of a Read Replica. If the instance is not a Read Replica, this
	// is blank.
	StatusInfos []*DBInstanceStatusInfo `locationNameList:"DBInstanceStatusInfo" type:"list"`

	// Specifies whether the DB instance is encrypted.
	StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the storage type associated with DB instance.
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// The ARN from the key store with which the instance is associated for TDE
	// encryption.
	TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The time zone of the DB instance. In most cases, the Timezone element is
	// empty. Timezone content appears only for Microsoft SQL Server DB instances
	// that were created with a time zone specified.
	Timezone *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides a list of VPC security group elements that the DB instance belongs
	// to.
	VpcSecurityGroups []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.

func (DBInstance) GoString

func (s DBInstance) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBInstance) SetAllocatedStorage

func (s *DBInstance) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBInstance

SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade

func (s *DBInstance) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *DBInstance

SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetAvailabilityZone

func (s *DBInstance) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBInstance

SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *DBInstance) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *DBInstance

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetCACertificateIdentifier

func (s *DBInstance) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance

SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetCharacterSetName

func (s *DBInstance) SetCharacterSetName(v string) *DBInstance

SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot

func (s *DBInstance) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *DBInstance

SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBInstanceArn

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceArn(v string) *DBInstance

SetDBInstanceArn sets the DBInstanceArn field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBInstanceClass

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *DBInstance

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBInstanceStatus

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBInstanceStatus(v string) *DBInstance

SetDBInstanceStatus sets the DBInstanceStatus field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBName

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBName(v string) *DBInstance

SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBParameterGroups

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBParameterGroups(v []*DBParameterGroupStatus) *DBInstance

SetDBParameterGroups sets the DBParameterGroups field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBSecurityGroups

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*DBSecurityGroupMembership) *DBInstance

SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDBSubnetGroup

func (s *DBInstance) SetDBSubnetGroup(v *DBSubnetGroup) *DBInstance

SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDbInstancePort

func (s *DBInstance) SetDbInstancePort(v int64) *DBInstance

SetDbInstancePort sets the DbInstancePort field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDbiResourceId

func (s *DBInstance) SetDbiResourceId(v string) *DBInstance

SetDbiResourceId sets the DbiResourceId field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetDomainMemberships

func (s *DBInstance) SetDomainMemberships(v []*DomainMembership) *DBInstance

SetDomainMemberships sets the DomainMemberships field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports

func (s *DBInstance) SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *DBInstance

SetEnabledCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnabledCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetEndpoint

func (s *DBInstance) SetEndpoint(v *Endpoint) *DBInstance

SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetEngine

func (s *DBInstance) SetEngine(v string) *DBInstance

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetEngineVersion

func (s *DBInstance) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBInstance

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetEnhancedMonitoringResourceArn

func (s *DBInstance) SetEnhancedMonitoringResourceArn(v string) *DBInstance

SetEnhancedMonitoringResourceArn sets the EnhancedMonitoringResourceArn field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled

func (s *DBInstance) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBInstance

SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetInstanceCreateTime

func (s *DBInstance) SetInstanceCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBInstance

SetInstanceCreateTime sets the InstanceCreateTime field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetIops

func (s *DBInstance) SetIops(v int64) *DBInstance

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetKmsKeyId

func (s *DBInstance) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBInstance

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetLatestRestorableTime

func (s *DBInstance) SetLatestRestorableTime(v time.Time) *DBInstance

SetLatestRestorableTime sets the LatestRestorableTime field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetLicenseModel

func (s *DBInstance) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBInstance

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetMasterUsername

func (s *DBInstance) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBInstance

SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetMonitoringInterval

func (s *DBInstance) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *DBInstance

SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetMonitoringRoleArn

func (s *DBInstance) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *DBInstance

SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetMultiAZ

func (s *DBInstance) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *DBInstance

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetOptionGroupMemberships

func (s *DBInstance) SetOptionGroupMemberships(v []*OptionGroupMembership) *DBInstance

SetOptionGroupMemberships sets the OptionGroupMemberships field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetPendingModifiedValues

func (s *DBInstance) SetPendingModifiedValues(v *PendingModifiedValues) *DBInstance

SetPendingModifiedValues sets the PendingModifiedValues field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsEnabled

func (s *DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsEnabled(v bool) *DBInstance

SetPerformanceInsightsEnabled sets the PerformanceInsightsEnabled field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId

func (s *DBInstance) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *DBInstance

SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *DBInstance) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *DBInstance

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow

func (s *DBInstance) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *DBInstance

SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetPromotionTier

func (s *DBInstance) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *DBInstance

SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetPubliclyAccessible

func (s *DBInstance) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *DBInstance

SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers

func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBInstance

SetReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaDBClusterIdentifiers field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers

func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers(v []*string) *DBInstance

SetReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers sets the ReadReplicaDBInstanceIdentifiers field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *DBInstance) SetReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBInstance

SetReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the ReadReplicaSourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetSecondaryAvailabilityZone

func (s *DBInstance) SetSecondaryAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBInstance

SetSecondaryAvailabilityZone sets the SecondaryAvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetStatusInfos

func (s *DBInstance) SetStatusInfos(v []*DBInstanceStatusInfo) *DBInstance

SetStatusInfos sets the StatusInfos field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetStorageEncrypted

func (s *DBInstance) SetStorageEncrypted(v bool) *DBInstance

SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetStorageType

func (s *DBInstance) SetStorageType(v string) *DBInstance

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetTdeCredentialArn

func (s *DBInstance) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *DBInstance

SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetTimezone

func (s *DBInstance) SetTimezone(v string) *DBInstance

SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.

func (*DBInstance) SetVpcSecurityGroups

func (s *DBInstance) SetVpcSecurityGroups(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *DBInstance

SetVpcSecurityGroups sets the VpcSecurityGroups field's value.

func (DBInstance) String

func (s DBInstance) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBInstanceStatusInfo

type DBInstanceStatusInfo struct {

	// Details of the error if there is an error for the instance. If the instance
	// is not in an error state, this value is blank.
	Message *string `type:"string"`

	// Boolean value that is true if the instance is operating normally, or false
	// if the instance is in an error state.
	Normal *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Status of the DB instance. For a StatusType of read replica, the values can
	// be replicating, error, stopped, or terminated.
	Status *string `type:"string"`

	// This value is currently "read replication."
	StatusType *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Provides a list of status information for a DB instance.

func (DBInstanceStatusInfo) GoString

func (s DBInstanceStatusInfo) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetMessage

SetMessage sets the Message field's value.

func (*DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetNormal

SetNormal sets the Normal field's value.

func (*DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetStatus

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (*DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetStatusType

func (s *DBInstanceStatusInfo) SetStatusType(v string) *DBInstanceStatusInfo

SetStatusType sets the StatusType field's value.

func (DBInstanceStatusInfo) String

func (s DBInstanceStatusInfo) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBParameterGroup

type DBParameterGroup struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB parameter group.
	DBParameterGroupArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the name of the DB parameter group family that this DB parameter
	// group is compatible with.
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the name of the DB parameter group.
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the customer-specified description for this DB parameter group.
	Description *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB parameter group.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBParameterGroups action.

func (DBParameterGroup) GoString

func (s DBParameterGroup) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupArn

func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupArn(v string) *DBParameterGroup

SetDBParameterGroupArn sets the DBParameterGroupArn field's value.

func (*DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DBParameterGroup

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroup

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*DBParameterGroup) SetDescription

func (s *DBParameterGroup) SetDescription(v string) *DBParameterGroup

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (DBParameterGroup) String

func (s DBParameterGroup) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBParameterGroupNameMessage

type DBParameterGroupNameMessage struct {

	// Provides the name of the DB parameter group.
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the ModifyDBParameterGroup or ResetDBParameterGroup action.

func (DBParameterGroupNameMessage) GoString

func (s DBParameterGroupNameMessage) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *DBParameterGroupNameMessage) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroupNameMessage

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (DBParameterGroupNameMessage) String

String returns the string representation

type DBParameterGroupStatus

type DBParameterGroupStatus struct {

	// The name of the DP parameter group.
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The status of parameter updates.
	ParameterApplyStatus *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

The status of the DB parameter group.

This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:

  • CreateDBInstance

  • CreateDBInstanceReadReplica

  • DeleteDBInstance

  • ModifyDBInstance

  • RebootDBInstance

  • RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot

func (DBParameterGroupStatus) GoString

func (s DBParameterGroupStatus) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBParameterGroupStatus) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *DBParameterGroupStatus) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DBParameterGroupStatus

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*DBParameterGroupStatus) SetParameterApplyStatus

func (s *DBParameterGroupStatus) SetParameterApplyStatus(v string) *DBParameterGroupStatus

SetParameterApplyStatus sets the ParameterApplyStatus field's value.

func (DBParameterGroupStatus) String

func (s DBParameterGroupStatus) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBSecurityGroup

type DBSecurityGroup struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB security group.
	DBSecurityGroupArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the description of the DB security group.
	DBSecurityGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the name of the DB security group.
	DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains a list of EC2SecurityGroup elements.
	EC2SecurityGroups []*EC2SecurityGroup `locationNameList:"EC2SecurityGroup" type:"list"`

	// Contains a list of IPRange elements.
	IPRanges []*IPRange `locationNameList:"IPRange" type:"list"`

	// Provides the AWS ID of the owner of a specific DB security group.
	OwnerId *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the VpcId of the DB security group.
	VpcId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups action.

func (DBSecurityGroup) GoString

func (s DBSecurityGroup) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupArn

func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupArn(v string) *DBSecurityGroup

SetDBSecurityGroupArn sets the DBSecurityGroupArn field's value.

func (*DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupDescription

func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupDescription(v string) *DBSecurityGroup

SetDBSecurityGroupDescription sets the DBSecurityGroupDescription field's value.

func (*DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupName

func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DBSecurityGroup

SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*DBSecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroups

func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroups(v []*EC2SecurityGroup) *DBSecurityGroup

SetEC2SecurityGroups sets the EC2SecurityGroups field's value.

func (*DBSecurityGroup) SetIPRanges

func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetIPRanges(v []*IPRange) *DBSecurityGroup

SetIPRanges sets the IPRanges field's value.

func (*DBSecurityGroup) SetOwnerId

func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetOwnerId(v string) *DBSecurityGroup

SetOwnerId sets the OwnerId field's value.

func (*DBSecurityGroup) SetVpcId

func (s *DBSecurityGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSecurityGroup

SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.

func (DBSecurityGroup) String

func (s DBSecurityGroup) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBSecurityGroupMembership

type DBSecurityGroupMembership struct {

	// The name of the DB security group.
	DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The status of the DB security group.
	Status *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:

  • ModifyDBInstance

  • RebootDBInstance

  • RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot

  • RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime

func (DBSecurityGroupMembership) GoString

func (s DBSecurityGroupMembership) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBSecurityGroupMembership) SetDBSecurityGroupName

func (s *DBSecurityGroupMembership) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DBSecurityGroupMembership

SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*DBSecurityGroupMembership) SetStatus

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (DBSecurityGroupMembership) String

func (s DBSecurityGroupMembership) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBSnapshot

type DBSnapshot struct {

	// Specifies the allocated storage size in gibibytes (GiB).
	AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the name of the Availability Zone the DB instance was located in
	// at the time of the DB snapshot.
	AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the DB instance identifier of the DB instance this DB snapshot
	// was created from.
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB snapshot.
	DBSnapshotArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the identifier for the DB snapshot.
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether the DB snapshot is encrypted.
	Encrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the name of the database engine.
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the version of the database engine.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// True if mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts to database
	// accounts is enabled, and otherwise false.
	IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated
	// Time (UTC).
	InstanceCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Specifies the Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value of the DB
	// instance at the time of the snapshot.
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// If Encrypted is true, the AWS KMS key identifier for the encrypted DB snapshot.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// License model information for the restored DB instance.
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the master username for the DB snapshot.
	MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the option group name for the DB snapshot.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The percentage of the estimated data that has been transferred.
	PercentProgress *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the port that the database engine was listening on at the time
	// of the snapshot.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Provides the time when the snapshot was taken, in Universal Coordinated Time
	// (UTC).
	SnapshotCreateTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Provides the type of the DB snapshot.
	SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB snapshot Amazon Resource Name (ARN) that the DB snapshot was copied
	// from. It only has value in case of cross-customer or cross-region copy.
	SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS Region that the DB snapshot was created in or copied from.
	SourceRegion *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the status of this DB snapshot.
	Status *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the storage type associated with DB snapshot.
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
	TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The time zone of the DB snapshot. In most cases, the Timezone element is
	// empty. Timezone content appears only for snapshots taken from Microsoft SQL
	// Server DB instances that were created with a time zone specified.
	Timezone *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the VPC ID associated with the DB snapshot.
	VpcId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.

func (DBSnapshot) GoString

func (s DBSnapshot) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBSnapshot) SetAllocatedStorage

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *DBSnapshot

SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetAvailabilityZone

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetAvailabilityZone(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetDBSnapshotArn

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBSnapshotArn(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetDBSnapshotArn sets the DBSnapshotArn field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetEncrypted

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEncrypted(v bool) *DBSnapshot

SetEncrypted sets the Encrypted field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetEngine

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEngine(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetEngineVersion

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetEngineVersion(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled(v bool) *DBSnapshot

SetIAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled sets the IAMDatabaseAuthenticationEnabled field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetInstanceCreateTime

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetInstanceCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBSnapshot

SetInstanceCreateTime sets the InstanceCreateTime field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetIops

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetIops(v int64) *DBSnapshot

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetKmsKeyId

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetKmsKeyId(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetLicenseModel

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetLicenseModel(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetMasterUsername

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetMasterUsername(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetPercentProgress

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetPercentProgress(v int64) *DBSnapshot

SetPercentProgress sets the PercentProgress field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetPort

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetPort(v int64) *DBSnapshot

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSnapshotCreateTime(v time.Time) *DBSnapshot

SetSnapshotCreateTime sets the SnapshotCreateTime field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetSnapshotType

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSnapshotType(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetSourceDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetSourceRegion

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetSourceRegion(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetSourceRegion sets the SourceRegion field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetStatus

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetStatus(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetStorageType

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetStorageType(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetTdeCredentialArn

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetTimezone

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetTimezone(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetTimezone sets the Timezone field's value.

func (*DBSnapshot) SetVpcId

func (s *DBSnapshot) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSnapshot

SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.

func (DBSnapshot) String

func (s DBSnapshot) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBSnapshotAttribute

type DBSnapshotAttribute struct {

	// The name of the manual DB snapshot attribute.
	//
	// The attribute named restore refers to the list of AWS accounts that have
	// permission to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information,
	// see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API action.
	AttributeName *string `type:"string"`

	// The value or values for the manual DB snapshot attribute.
	//
	// If the AttributeName field is set to restore, then this element returns a
	// list of IDs of the AWS accounts that are authorized to copy or restore the
	// manual DB snapshot. If a value of all is in the list, then the manual DB
	// snapshot is public and available for any AWS account to copy or restore.
	AttributeValues []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the name and values of a manual DB snapshot attribute

Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API.

func (DBSnapshotAttribute) GoString

func (s DBSnapshotAttribute) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeName

func (s *DBSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeName(v string) *DBSnapshotAttribute

SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.

func (*DBSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeValues

func (s *DBSnapshotAttribute) SetAttributeValues(v []*string) *DBSnapshotAttribute

SetAttributeValues sets the AttributeValues field's value.

func (DBSnapshotAttribute) String

func (s DBSnapshotAttribute) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DBSnapshotAttributesResult

type DBSnapshotAttributesResult struct {

	// The list of attributes and values for the manual DB snapshot.
	DBSnapshotAttributes []*DBSnapshotAttribute `locationNameList:"DBSnapshotAttribute" type:"list"`

	// The identifier of the manual DB snapshot that the attributes apply to.
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes API action.

Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API action.

func (DBSnapshotAttributesResult) GoString

func (s DBSnapshotAttributesResult) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBSnapshotAttributes

SetDBSnapshotAttributes sets the DBSnapshotAttributes field's value.

func (*DBSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DBSnapshotAttributesResult) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DBSnapshotAttributesResult

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (DBSnapshotAttributesResult) String

String returns the string representation

type DBSubnetGroup

type DBSubnetGroup struct {

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the DB subnet group.
	DBSubnetGroupArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the description of the DB subnet group.
	DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the DB subnet group.
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the status of the DB subnet group.
	SubnetGroupStatus *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains a list of Subnet elements.
	Subnets []*Subnet `locationNameList:"Subnet" type:"list"`

	// Provides the VpcId of the DB subnet group.
	VpcId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups action.

func (DBSubnetGroup) GoString

func (s DBSubnetGroup) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupArn

func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupArn(v string) *DBSubnetGroup

SetDBSubnetGroupArn sets the DBSubnetGroupArn field's value.

func (*DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription

func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *DBSubnetGroup

SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.

func (*DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupName

func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *DBSubnetGroup

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*DBSubnetGroup) SetSubnetGroupStatus

func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetSubnetGroupStatus(v string) *DBSubnetGroup

SetSubnetGroupStatus sets the SubnetGroupStatus field's value.

func (*DBSubnetGroup) SetSubnets

func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetSubnets(v []*Subnet) *DBSubnetGroup

SetSubnets sets the Subnets field's value.

func (*DBSubnetGroup) SetVpcId

func (s *DBSubnetGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *DBSubnetGroup

SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.

func (DBSubnetGroup) String

func (s DBSubnetGroup) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DeleteDBClusterInput

type DeleteDBClusterInput struct {

	// The DB cluster identifier for the DB cluster to be deleted. This parameter
	// isn't case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match an existing DBClusterIdentifier.
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The DB cluster snapshot identifier of the new DB cluster snapshot created
	// when SkipFinalSnapshot is set to false.
	//
	// Specifying this parameter and also setting the SkipFinalShapshot parameter
	// to true results in an error.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Determines whether a final DB cluster snapshot is created before the DB cluster
	// is deleted. If true is specified, no DB cluster snapshot is created. If false
	// is specified, a DB cluster snapshot is created before the DB cluster is deleted.
	//
	// You must specify a FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier parameter if SkipFinalSnapshot
	// is false.
	//
	// Default: false
	SkipFinalSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBClusterInput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBClusterInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterInput

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*DeleteDBClusterInput) SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterInput

SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*DeleteDBClusterInput) SetSkipFinalSnapshot

func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) SetSkipFinalSnapshot(v bool) *DeleteDBClusterInput

SetSkipFinalSnapshot sets the SkipFinalSnapshot field's value.

func (DeleteDBClusterInput) String

func (s DeleteDBClusterInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBClusterInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteDBClusterInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteDBClusterOutput

type DeleteDBClusterOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
	DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBClusterOutput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBClusterOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster

SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.

func (DeleteDBClusterOutput) String

func (s DeleteDBClusterOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput

type DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be the name of an existing DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	//    * You can't delete a default DB cluster parameter group.
	//
	//    * Cannot be associated with any DB clusters.
	//
	// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput

type DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput

type DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput struct {

	// The identifier of the DB cluster snapshot to delete.
	//
	// Constraints: Must be the name of an existing DB cluster snapshot in the available
	// state.
	//
	// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput

SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput

type DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB cluster snapshot
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
	// action.
	DBClusterSnapshot *DBClusterSnapshot `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshot

SetDBClusterSnapshot sets the DBClusterSnapshot field's value.

func (DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DeleteDBInstanceInput

type DeleteDBInstanceInput struct {

	// The DB instance identifier for the DB instance to be deleted. This parameter
	// isn't case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the name of an existing DB instance.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The DBSnapshotIdentifier of the new DBSnapshot created when SkipFinalSnapshot
	// is set to false.
	//
	// Specifying this parameter and also setting the SkipFinalShapshot parameter
	// to true results in an error.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 255 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	//    * Cannot be specified when deleting a Read Replica.
	FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Determines whether a final DB snapshot is created before the DB instance
	// is deleted. If true is specified, no DBSnapshot is created. If false is specified,
	// a DB snapshot is created before the DB instance is deleted.
	//
	// Note that when a DB instance is in a failure state and has a status of 'failed',
	// 'incompatible-restore', or 'incompatible-network', it can only be deleted
	// when the SkipFinalSnapshot parameter is set to "true".
	//
	// Specify true when deleting a Read Replica.
	//
	// The FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier parameter must be specified if SkipFinalSnapshot
	// is false.
	//
	// Default: false
	SkipFinalSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBInstanceInput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBInstanceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBInstanceInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBInstanceInput

SetFinalDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the FinalDBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetSkipFinalSnapshot

func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) SetSkipFinalSnapshot(v bool) *DeleteDBInstanceInput

SetSkipFinalSnapshot sets the SkipFinalSnapshot field's value.

func (DeleteDBInstanceInput) String

func (s DeleteDBInstanceInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBInstanceInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteDBInstanceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteDBInstanceOutput

type DeleteDBInstanceOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBInstanceOutput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (DeleteDBInstanceOutput) String

func (s DeleteDBInstanceOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DeleteDBParameterGroupInput

type DeleteDBParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the DB parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be the name of an existing DB parameter group
	//
	//    * You can't delete a default DB parameter group
	//
	//    * Cannot be associated with any DB instances
	//
	// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput

type DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput

type DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the DB security group to delete.
	//
	// You can't delete the default DB security group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 255 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	//    * Must not be "Default"
	//
	// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
	DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName

func (s *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput

SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.

func (DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput

type DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DeleteDBSnapshotInput

type DeleteDBSnapshotInput struct {

	// The DBSnapshot identifier.
	//
	// Constraints: Must be the name of an existing DB snapshot in the available
	// state.
	//
	// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBSnapshotInput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DeleteDBSnapshotInput

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (DeleteDBSnapshotInput) String

func (s DeleteDBSnapshotInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBSnapshotInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteDBSnapshotOutput

type DeleteDBSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
	DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot

SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.

func (DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) String

func (s DeleteDBSnapshotOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput

type DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the database subnet group to delete.
	//
	// You can't delete the default subnet group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
	// default.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	//
	// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

func (s *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) String

func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput

type DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString

func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) String

func (s DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DeleteEventSubscriptionInput

type DeleteEventSubscriptionInput struct {

	// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to delete.
	//
	// SubscriptionName is a required field
	SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) GoString

func (s DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName

SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.

func (DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput

type DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
	// action.
	EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription

SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.

func (DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DeleteOptionGroupInput

type DeleteOptionGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the option group to be deleted.
	//
	// You can't delete default option groups.
	//
	// OptionGroupName is a required field
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteOptionGroupInput) GoString

func (s DeleteOptionGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DeleteOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *DeleteOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *DeleteOptionGroupInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (DeleteOptionGroupInput) String

func (s DeleteOptionGroupInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DeleteOptionGroupInput) Validate

func (s *DeleteOptionGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DeleteOptionGroupOutput

type DeleteOptionGroupOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DeleteOptionGroupOutput) GoString

func (s DeleteOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (DeleteOptionGroupOutput) String

func (s DeleteOptionGroupOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DescribeAccountAttributesInput

type DescribeAccountAttributesInput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeAccountAttributesInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (DescribeAccountAttributesInput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeAccountAttributesOutput

type DescribeAccountAttributesOutput struct {

	// A list of AccountQuota objects. Within this list, each quota has a name,
	// a count of usage toward the quota maximum, and a maximum value for the quota.
	AccountQuotas []*AccountQuota `locationNameList:"AccountQuota" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Data returned by the DescribeAccountAttributes action.

func (DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) SetAccountQuotas

SetAccountQuotas sets the AccountQuotas field's value.

func (DescribeAccountAttributesOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeCertificatesInput

type DescribeCertificatesInput struct {

	// The user-supplied certificate identifier. If this parameter is specified,
	// information for only the identified certificate is returned. This parameter
	// isn't case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match an existing CertificateIdentifier.
	CertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeCertificates
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeCertificatesInput) GoString

func (s DescribeCertificatesInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeCertificatesInput) SetCertificateIdentifier

func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) SetCertificateIdentifier(v string) *DescribeCertificatesInput

SetCertificateIdentifier sets the CertificateIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeCertificatesInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeCertificatesInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeCertificatesInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeCertificatesInput) String

func (s DescribeCertificatesInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeCertificatesInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeCertificatesInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeCertificatesOutput

type DescribeCertificatesOutput struct {

	// The list of Certificate objects for the AWS account.
	Certificates []*Certificate `locationNameList:"Certificate" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeCertificates
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Data returned by the DescribeCertificates action.

func (DescribeCertificatesOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeCertificatesOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeCertificatesOutput) SetCertificates

SetCertificates sets the Certificates field's value.

func (*DescribeCertificatesOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeCertificatesOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput

type DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput struct {

	// The name of a specific DB cluster parameter group to return details for.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput

type DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput struct {

	// A list of DB cluster parameter groups.
	DBClusterParameterGroups []*DBClusterParameterGroup `locationNameList:"DBClusterParameterGroup" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) SetDBClusterParameterGroups

SetDBClusterParameterGroups sets the DBClusterParameterGroups field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBClusterParametersInput

type DescribeDBClusterParametersInput struct {

	// The name of a specific DB cluster parameter group to return parameter details
	// for.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
	//
	// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameters
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// A value that indicates to return only parameters for a specific source. Parameter
	// sources can be engine, service, or customer.
	Source *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

func (s *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) SetSource

SetSource sets the Source field's value.

func (DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput

type DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterParameters
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides a list of parameters for the DB cluster parameter group.
	Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Provides details about a DB cluster parameter group including the parameters in the DB cluster parameter group.

func (DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) SetParameters

SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.

func (DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput

type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput struct {

	// The identifier for the DB cluster snapshot to describe the attributes for.
	//
	// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput

type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
	// API action.
	//
	// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
	// to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see
	// the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
	DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult

SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.

func (DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput

type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput struct {

	// The ID of the DB cluster to retrieve the list of DB cluster snapshots for.
	// This parameter can't be used in conjunction with the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier
	// parameter. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// A specific DB cluster snapshot identifier to describe. This parameter can't
	// be used in conjunction with the DBClusterIdentifier parameter. This value
	// is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBClusterSnapshot.
	//
	//    * If this identifier is for an automated snapshot, the SnapshotType parameter
	//    must also be specified.
	DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// True to include manual DB cluster snapshots that are public and can be copied
	// or restored by any AWS account, and otherwise false. The default is false.
	// The default is false.
	//
	// You can share a manual DB cluster snapshot as public by using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute
	// API action.
	IncludePublic *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// True to include shared manual DB cluster snapshots from other AWS accounts
	// that this AWS account has been given permission to copy or restore, and otherwise
	// false. The default is false.
	//
	// You can give an AWS account permission to restore a manual DB cluster snapshot
	// from another AWS account by the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
	IncludeShared *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The type of DB cluster snapshots to be returned. You can specify one of the
	// following values:
	//
	//    * automated - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been automatically
	//    taken by Amazon RDS for my AWS account.
	//
	//    * manual - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been taken by my
	//    AWS account.
	//
	//    * shared - Return all manual DB cluster snapshots that have been shared
	//    to my AWS account.
	//
	//    * public - Return all DB cluster snapshots that have been marked as public.
	//
	// If you don't specify a SnapshotType value, then both automated and manual
	// DB cluster snapshots are returned. You can include shared DB cluster snapshots
	// with these results by setting the IncludeShared parameter to true. You can
	// include public DB cluster snapshots with these results by setting the IncludePublic
	// parameter to true.
	//
	// The IncludeShared and IncludePublic parameters don't apply for SnapshotType
	// values of manual or automated. The IncludePublic parameter doesn't apply
	// when SnapshotType is set to shared. The IncludeShared parameter doesn't apply
	// when SnapshotType is set to public.
	SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput

SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetIncludePublic

SetIncludePublic sets the IncludePublic field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetIncludeShared

SetIncludeShared sets the IncludeShared field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotType

SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.

func (DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput

type DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput struct {

	// Provides a list of DB cluster snapshots for the user.
	DBClusterSnapshots []*DBClusterSnapshot `locationNameList:"DBClusterSnapshot" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusterSnapshots
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Provides a list of DB cluster snapshots for the user as the result of a call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots action.

func (DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshots

SetDBClusterSnapshots sets the DBClusterSnapshots field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBClustersInput

type DescribeDBClustersInput struct {

	// The user-supplied DB cluster identifier. If this parameter is specified,
	// information from only the specific DB cluster is returned. This parameter
	// isn't case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match an existing DBClusterIdentifier.
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// A filter that specifies one or more DB clusters to describe.
	//
	// Supported filters:
	//
	//    * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
	//    Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
	//    about the DB clusters identified by these ARNs.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBClusters request.
	// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
	// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBClustersInput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBClustersInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClustersInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBClustersInput

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClustersInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClustersInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClustersInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeDBClustersInput) String

func (s DescribeDBClustersInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClustersInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBClustersInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBClustersOutput

type DescribeDBClustersOutput struct {

	// Contains a list of DB clusters for the user.
	DBClusters []*DBCluster `locationNameList:"DBCluster" type:"list"`

	// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DescribeDBClusters request.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBClusters action.

func (DescribeDBClustersOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBClustersOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBClustersOutput) SetDBClusters

SetDBClusters sets the DBClusters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBClustersOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBClustersOutput) String

func (s DescribeDBClustersOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput

type DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput struct {

	// The name of a specific DB parameter group family to return details for.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match an existing DBParameterGroupFamily.
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates that only the default version of the specified engine or engine
	// and major version combination is returned.
	DefaultOnly *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The database engine to return.
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// The database engine version to return.
	//
	// Example: 5.1.49
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// Not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// If this parameter is specified and the requested engine supports the CharacterSetName
	// parameter for CreateDBInstance, the response includes a list of supported
	// character sets for each engine version.
	ListSupportedCharacterSets *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// If this parameter is specified and the requested engine supports the TimeZone
	// parameter for CreateDBInstance, the response includes a list of supported
	// time zones for each engine version.
	ListSupportedTimezones *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
	// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
	// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetDefaultOnly

SetDefaultOnly sets the DefaultOnly field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetEngineVersion

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetListSupportedCharacterSets

func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetListSupportedCharacterSets(v bool) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput

SetListSupportedCharacterSets sets the ListSupportedCharacterSets field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetListSupportedTimezones

func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetListSupportedTimezones(v bool) *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput

SetListSupportedTimezones sets the ListSupportedTimezones field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput

type DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput struct {

	// A list of DBEngineVersion elements.
	DBEngineVersions []*DBEngineVersion `locationNameList:"DBEngineVersion" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBEngineVersions action.

func (DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) SetDBEngineVersions

SetDBEngineVersions sets the DBEngineVersions field's value.

func (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBInstancesInput

type DescribeDBInstancesInput struct {

	// The user-supplied instance identifier. If this parameter is specified, information
	// from only the specific DB instance is returned. This parameter isn't case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// A filter that specifies one or more DB instances to describe.
	//
	// Supported filters:
	//
	//    * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
	//    Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
	//    about the DB instances associated with the DB clusters identified by these
	//    ARNs.
	//
	//    * db-instance-id - Accepts DB instance identifiers and DB instance Amazon
	//    Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include information
	//    about the DB instances identified by these ARNs.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBInstances request.
	// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
	// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBInstancesInput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBInstancesInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBInstancesInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBInstancesInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeDBInstancesInput) String

func (s DescribeDBInstancesInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBInstancesInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBInstancesInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBInstancesOutput

type DescribeDBInstancesOutput struct {

	// A list of DBInstance instances.
	DBInstances []*DBInstance `locationNameList:"DBInstance" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords .
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBInstances action.

func (DescribeDBInstancesOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBInstancesOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBInstancesOutput) SetDBInstances

SetDBInstances sets the DBInstances field's value.

func (*DescribeDBInstancesOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBInstancesOutput) String

func (s DescribeDBInstancesOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBLogFilesDetails

type DescribeDBLogFilesDetails struct {

	// A POSIX timestamp when the last log entry was written.
	LastWritten *int64 `type:"long"`

	// The name of the log file for the specified DB instance.
	LogFileName *string `type:"string"`

	// The size, in bytes, of the log file for the specified DB instance.
	Size *int64 `type:"long"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element to DescribeDBLogFiles.

func (DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) GoString

func (s DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetLastWritten

SetLastWritten sets the LastWritten field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetLogFileName

SetLogFileName sets the LogFileName field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) SetSize

SetSize sets the Size field's value.

func (DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) String

func (s DescribeDBLogFilesDetails) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBLogFilesInput

type DescribeDBLogFilesInput struct {

	// The customer-assigned name of the DB instance that contains the log files
	// you want to list.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Filters the available log files for files written since the specified date,
	// in POSIX timestamp format with milliseconds.
	FileLastWritten *int64 `type:"long"`

	// Filters the available log files for files larger than the specified size.
	FileSize *int64 `type:"long"`

	// Filters the available log files for log file names that contain the specified
	// string.
	FilenameContains *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// The pagination token provided in the previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBLogFilesInput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBLogFilesInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFileLastWritten

func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFileLastWritten(v int64) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput

SetFileLastWritten sets the FileLastWritten field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFileSize

SetFileSize sets the FileSize field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFilenameContains

func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFilenameContains(v string) *DescribeDBLogFilesInput

SetFilenameContains sets the FilenameContains field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeDBLogFilesInput) String

func (s DescribeDBLogFilesInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBLogFilesOutput

type DescribeDBLogFilesOutput struct {

	// The DB log files returned.
	DescribeDBLogFiles []*DescribeDBLogFilesDetails `locationNameList:"DescribeDBLogFilesDetails" type:"list"`

	// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DescribeDBLogFiles request.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

The response from a call to DescribeDBLogFiles.

func (DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) SetDescribeDBLogFiles

SetDescribeDBLogFiles sets the DescribeDBLogFiles field's value.

func (*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) String

func (s DescribeDBLogFilesOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput

type DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput struct {

	// The name of a specific DB parameter group to return details for.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBParameterGroups
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetDBParameterGroupName

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput

type DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput struct {

	// A list of DBParameterGroup instances.
	DBParameterGroups []*DBParameterGroup `locationNameList:"DBParameterGroup" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBParameterGroups action.

func (DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) SetDBParameterGroups

SetDBParameterGroups sets the DBParameterGroups field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBParametersInput

type DescribeDBParametersInput struct {

	// The name of a specific DB parameter group to return details for.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
	//
	// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBParameters
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The parameter types to return.
	//
	// Default: All parameter types returned
	//
	// Valid Values: user | system | engine-default
	Source *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBParametersInput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBParametersInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *DescribeDBParametersInput

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParametersInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParametersInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParametersInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParametersInput) SetSource

SetSource sets the Source field's value.

func (DescribeDBParametersInput) String

func (s DescribeDBParametersInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBParametersInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBParametersInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBParametersOutput

type DescribeDBParametersOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of Parameter values.
	Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBParameters action.

func (DescribeDBParametersOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBParametersOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBParametersOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBParametersOutput) SetParameters

SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.

func (DescribeDBParametersOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput

type DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput struct {

	// The name of the DB security group to return details for.
	DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSecurityGroups
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName

SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput

type DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput struct {

	// A list of DBSecurityGroup instances.
	DBSecurityGroups []*DBSecurityGroup `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSecurityGroups action.

func (DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) SetDBSecurityGroups

SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput

type DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput struct {

	// The identifier for the DB snapshot to describe the attributes for.
	//
	// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput

type DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
	// API action.
	//
	// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
	// copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
	// API action.
	DBSnapshotAttributesResult *DBSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult

SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.

func (DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBSnapshotsInput

type DescribeDBSnapshotsInput struct {

	// The ID of the DB instance to retrieve the list of DB snapshots for. This
	// parameter can't be used in conjunction with DBSnapshotIdentifier. This parameter
	// is not case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// A specific DB snapshot identifier to describe. This parameter can't be used
	// in conjunction with DBInstanceIdentifier. This value is stored as a lowercase
	// string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the identifier of an existing DBSnapshot.
	//
	//    * If this identifier is for an automated snapshot, the SnapshotType parameter
	//    must also be specified.
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// True to include manual DB snapshots that are public and can be copied or
	// restored by any AWS account, and otherwise false. The default is false.
	//
	// You can share a manual DB snapshot as public by using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
	// API.
	IncludePublic *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// True to include shared manual DB snapshots from other AWS accounts that this
	// AWS account has been given permission to copy or restore, and otherwise false.
	// The default is false.
	//
	// You can give an AWS account permission to restore a manual DB snapshot from
	// another AWS account by using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API action.
	IncludeShared *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSnapshots request.
	// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
	// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The type of snapshots to be returned. You can specify one of the following
	// values:
	//
	//    * automated - Return all DB snapshots that have been automatically taken
	//    by Amazon RDS for my AWS account.
	//
	//    * manual - Return all DB snapshots that have been taken by my AWS account.
	//
	//    * shared - Return all manual DB snapshots that have been shared to my
	//    AWS account.
	//
	//    * public - Return all DB snapshots that have been marked as public.
	//
	// If you don't specify a SnapshotType value, then both automated and manual
	// snapshots are returned. Shared and public DB snapshots are not included in
	// the returned results by default. You can include shared snapshots with these
	// results by setting the IncludeShared parameter to true. You can include public
	// snapshots with these results by setting the IncludePublic parameter to true.
	//
	// The IncludeShared and IncludePublic parameters don't apply for SnapshotType
	// values of manual or automated. The IncludePublic parameter doesn't apply
	// when SnapshotType is set to shared. The IncludeShared parameter doesn't apply
	// when SnapshotType is set to public.
	SnapshotType *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetIncludePublic

func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetIncludePublic(v bool) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput

SetIncludePublic sets the IncludePublic field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetIncludeShared

func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetIncludeShared(v bool) *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput

SetIncludeShared sets the IncludeShared field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) SetSnapshotType

SetSnapshotType sets the SnapshotType field's value.

func (DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) String

func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput

type DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput struct {

	// A list of DBSnapshot instances.
	DBSnapshots []*DBSnapshot `locationNameList:"DBSnapshot" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSnapshots action.

func (DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) SetDBSnapshots

SetDBSnapshots sets the DBSnapshots field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) String

func (s DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput

type DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput struct {

	// The name of the DB subnet group to return details for.
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeDBSubnetGroups
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput

type DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput struct {

	// A list of DBSubnetGroup instances.
	DBSubnetGroups []*DBSubnetGroup `locationNameList:"DBSubnetGroup" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeDBSubnetGroups action.

func (DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) SetDBSubnetGroups

SetDBSubnetGroups sets the DBSubnetGroups field's value.

func (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput

type DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group family to return engine parameter
	// information for.
	//
	// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput

type DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput struct {

	// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
	// action.
	EngineDefaults *EngineDefaults `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) SetEngineDefaults

SetEngineDefaults sets the EngineDefaults field's value.

func (DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput

type DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput struct {

	// The name of the DB parameter group family.
	//
	// DBParameterGroupFamily is a required field
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput

type DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput struct {

	// Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters
	// action.
	EngineDefaults *EngineDefaults `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) SetEngineDefaults

SetEngineDefaults sets the EngineDefaults field's value.

func (DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeEventCategoriesInput

type DescribeEventCategoriesInput struct {

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// The type of source that is generating the events.
	//
	// Valid values: db-instance | db-parameter-group | db-security-group | db-snapshot
	SourceType *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeEventCategoriesInput) GoString

func (s DescribeEventCategoriesInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventCategoriesInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeEventCategoriesInput) SetSourceType

SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.

func (DescribeEventCategoriesInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventCategoriesInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeEventCategoriesOutput

type DescribeEventCategoriesOutput struct {

	// A list of EventCategoriesMap data types.
	EventCategoriesMapList []*EventCategoriesMap `locationNameList:"EventCategoriesMap" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Data returned from the DescribeEventCategories action.

func (DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) SetEventCategoriesMapList

SetEventCategoriesMapList sets the EventCategoriesMapList field's value.

func (DescribeEventCategoriesOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput

type DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput struct {

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to describe.
	SubscriptionName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) SetSubscriptionName

SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.

func (DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput

type DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput struct {

	// A list of EventSubscriptions data types.
	EventSubscriptionsList []*EventSubscription `locationNameList:"EventSubscription" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Data returned by the DescribeEventSubscriptions action.

func (DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) SetEventSubscriptionsList

SetEventSubscriptionsList sets the EventSubscriptionsList field's value.

func (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeEventsInput

type DescribeEventsInput struct {

	// The number of minutes to retrieve events for.
	//
	// Default: 60
	Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The end of the time interval for which to retrieve events, specified in ISO
	// 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia
	// page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601)
	//
	// Example: 2009-07-08T18:00Z
	EndTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// A list of event categories that trigger notifications for a event notification
	// subscription.
	EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeEvents request.
	// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
	// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The identifier of the event source for which events are returned. If not
	// specified, then all sources are included in the response.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If SourceIdentifier is supplied, SourceType must also be provided.
	//
	//    * If the source type is DBInstance, then a DBInstanceIdentifier must be
	//    supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is DBSecurityGroup, a DBSecurityGroupName must be
	//    supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is DBParameterGroup, a DBParameterGroupName must
	//    be supplied.
	//
	//    * If the source type is DBSnapshot, a DBSnapshotIdentifier must be supplied.
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The event source to retrieve events for. If no value is specified, all events
	// are returned.
	SourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"SourceType"`

	// The beginning of the time interval to retrieve events for, specified in ISO
	// 8601 format. For more information about ISO 8601, go to the ISO8601 Wikipedia
	// page. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ISO_8601)
	//
	// Example: 2009-07-08T18:00Z
	StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeEventsInput) GoString

func (s DescribeEventsInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetDuration

func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetDuration(v int64) *DescribeEventsInput

SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetEndTime

SetEndTime sets the EndTime field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetEventCategories

func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *DescribeEventsInput

SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetFilters

func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetFilters(v []*Filter) *DescribeEventsInput

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetMaxRecords

func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetMaxRecords(v int64) *DescribeEventsInput

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceIdentifier

func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *DescribeEventsInput

SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceType

func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetSourceType(v string) *DescribeEventsInput

SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsInput) SetStartTime

func (s *DescribeEventsInput) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *DescribeEventsInput

SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value.

func (DescribeEventsInput) String

func (s DescribeEventsInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeEventsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeEventsOutput

type DescribeEventsOutput struct {

	// A list of Event instances.
	Events []*Event `locationNameList:"Event" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous Events request. If this
	// parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker,
	// up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEvents action.

func (DescribeEventsOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeEventsOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeEventsOutput) SetEvents

func (s *DescribeEventsOutput) SetEvents(v []*Event) *DescribeEventsOutput

SetEvents sets the Events field's value.

func (*DescribeEventsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DescribeEventsOutput) String

func (s DescribeEventsOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput

type DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput struct {

	// A required parameter. Options available for the given engine name are described.
	//
	// EngineName is a required field
	EngineName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// If specified, filters the results to include only options for the specified
	// major engine version.
	MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetEngineName

SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMajorEngineVersion

SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput

type DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// List of available option group options.
	OptionGroupOptions []*OptionGroupOption `locationNameList:"OptionGroupOption" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) SetOptionGroupOptions

SetOptionGroupOptions sets the OptionGroupOptions field's value.

func (DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeOptionGroupsInput

type DescribeOptionGroupsInput struct {

	// Filters the list of option groups to only include groups associated with
	// a specific database engine.
	EngineName *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// Filters the list of option groups to only include groups associated with
	// a specific database engine version. If specified, then EngineName must also
	// be specified.
	MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOptionGroups
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The name of the option group to describe. Cannot be supplied together with
	// EngineName or MajorEngineVersion.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeOptionGroupsInput) GoString

func (s DescribeOptionGroupsInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetEngineName

SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMajorEngineVersion

func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *DescribeOptionGroupsInput

SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsInput) SetOptionGroupName

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (DescribeOptionGroupsInput) String

func (s DescribeOptionGroupsInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeOptionGroupsOutput

type DescribeOptionGroupsOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// List of option groups.
	OptionGroupsList []*OptionGroup `locationNameList:"OptionGroup" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

List of option groups.

func (DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) SetOptionGroupsList

SetOptionGroupsList sets the OptionGroupsList field's value.

func (DescribeOptionGroupsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput

type DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput struct {

	// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
	// available offerings matching the specified DB instance class.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the engine to retrieve DB instance options for.
	//
	// Engine is a required field
	Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The engine version filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
	// available offerings matching the specified engine version.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// The license model filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
	// offerings matching the specified license model.
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The VPC filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available VPC
	// or non-VPC offerings.
	Vpc *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetEngineVersion

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetLicenseModel

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) SetVpc

SetVpc sets the Vpc field's value.

func (DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput

type DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous OrderableDBInstanceOptions
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// An OrderableDBInstanceOption structure containing information about orderable
	// options for the DB instance.
	OrderableDBInstanceOptions []*OrderableDBInstanceOption `locationNameList:"OrderableDBInstanceOption" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions action.

func (DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) SetOrderableDBInstanceOptions

SetOrderableDBInstanceOptions sets the OrderableDBInstanceOptions field's value.

func (DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput

type DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput struct {

	// A filter that specifies one or more resources to return pending maintenance
	// actions for.
	//
	// Supported filters:
	//
	//    * db-cluster-id - Accepts DB cluster identifiers and DB cluster Amazon
	//    Resource Names (ARNs). The results list will only include pending maintenance
	//    actions for the DB clusters identified by these ARNs.
	//
	//    * db-instance-id - Accepts DB instance identifiers and DB instance ARNs.
	//    The results list will only include pending maintenance actions for the
	//    DB instances identified by these ARNs.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to a number of records specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The ARN of a resource to return pending maintenance actions for.
	ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) SetResourceIdentifier

SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.

func (DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput

type DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribePendingMaintenanceActions
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to a number of records specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of the pending maintenance actions for the resource.
	PendingMaintenanceActions []*ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions `locationNameList:"ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Data returned from the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions action.

func (DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) SetPendingMaintenanceActions

SetPendingMaintenanceActions sets the PendingMaintenanceActions field's value.

func (DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput

type DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput struct {

	// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only those
	// reservations matching the specified DB instances class.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// The duration filter value, specified in years or seconds. Specify this parameter
	// to show only reservations for this duration.
	//
	// Valid Values: 1 | 3 | 31536000 | 94608000
	Duration *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
	// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
	// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The Multi-AZ filter value. Specify this parameter to show only those reservations
	// matching the specified Multi-AZ parameter.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The offering type filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
	// offerings matching the specified offering type.
	//
	// Valid Values: "Partial Upfront" | "All Upfront" | "No Upfront"
	OfferingType *string `type:"string"`

	// The product description filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
	// those reservations matching the specified product description.
	ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The reserved DB instance identifier filter value. Specify this parameter
	// to show only the reservation that matches the specified reservation ID.
	ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`

	// The offering identifier filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
	// purchased reservations matching the specified offering identifier.
	ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetDuration

SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetOfferingType

SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetProductDescription

SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetReservedDBInstanceId

SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId

func (s *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput

SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.

func (DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput

type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput struct {

	// The DB instance class filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
	// available offerings matching the specified DB instance class.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// Duration filter value, specified in years or seconds. Specify this parameter
	// to show only reservations for this duration.
	//
	// Valid Values: 1 | 3 | 31536000 | 94608000
	Duration *string `type:"string"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more than the
	// MaxRecords value is available, a pagination token called a marker is included
	// in the response so that the following results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The Multi-AZ filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
	// offerings matching the specified Multi-AZ parameter.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The offering type filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the available
	// offerings matching the specified offering type.
	//
	// Valid Values: "Partial Upfront" | "All Upfront" | "No Upfront"
	OfferingType *string `type:"string"`

	// Product description filter value. Specify this parameter to show only the
	// available offerings matching the specified product description.
	ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The offering identifier filter value. Specify this parameter to show only
	// the available offering that matches the specified reservation identifier.
	//
	// Example: 438012d3-4052-4cc7-b2e3-8d3372e0e706
	ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetDuration

SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetOfferingType

SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetProductDescription

SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId

SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.

func (DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput

type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of reserved DB instance offerings.
	ReservedDBInstancesOfferings []*ReservedDBInstancesOffering `locationNameList:"ReservedDBInstancesOffering" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings action.

func (DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferings

SetReservedDBInstancesOfferings sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferings field's value.

func (DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput

type DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of reserved DB instances.
	ReservedDBInstances []*ReservedDBInstance `locationNameList:"ReservedDBInstance" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeReservedDBInstances action.

func (DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) SetReservedDBInstances

SetReservedDBInstances sets the ReservedDBInstances field's value.

func (DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeSourceRegionsInput

type DescribeSourceRegionsInput struct {

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous DescribeSourceRegions
	// request. If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records
	// beyond the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The maximum number of records to include in the response. If more records
	// exist than the specified MaxRecords value, a pagination token called a marker
	// is included in the response so that the remaining results can be retrieved.
	//
	// Default: 100
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 20, maximum 100.
	MaxRecords *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The source AWS Region name. For example, us-east-1.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must specify a valid AWS Region name.
	RegionName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeSourceRegionsInput) GoString

func (s DescribeSourceRegionsInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetMaxRecords

SetMaxRecords sets the MaxRecords field's value.

func (*DescribeSourceRegionsInput) SetRegionName

SetRegionName sets the RegionName field's value.

func (DescribeSourceRegionsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeSourceRegionsInput) Validate

func (s *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeSourceRegionsOutput

type DescribeSourceRegionsOutput struct {

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous request. If this parameter
	// is specified, the response includes only records beyond the marker, up to
	// the value specified by MaxRecords.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of SourceRegion instances that contains each source AWS Region that
	// the current AWS Region can get a Read Replica or a DB snapshot from.
	SourceRegions []*SourceRegion `locationNameList:"SourceRegion" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeSourceRegions action.

func (DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) GoString

func (s DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) SetSourceRegions

SetSourceRegions sets the SourceRegions field's value.

func (DescribeSourceRegionsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput

type DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput struct {

	// The customer identifier or the ARN of your DB instance.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput

type DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput struct {

	// Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance.
	// Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications
	// action. You can use this information when you call ModifyDBInstance.
	ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage *ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) SetValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage

SetValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage sets the ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage field's value.

func (DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type DomainMembership

type DomainMembership struct {

	// The identifier of the Active Directory Domain.
	Domain *string `type:"string"`

	// The fully qualified domain name of the Active Directory Domain.
	FQDN *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the Directory
	// Service.
	IAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`

	// The status of the DB instance's Active Directory Domain membership, such
	// as joined, pending-join, failed etc).
	Status *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

An Active Directory Domain membership record associated with the DB instance.

func (DomainMembership) GoString

func (s DomainMembership) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DomainMembership) SetDomain

func (s *DomainMembership) SetDomain(v string) *DomainMembership

SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.

func (*DomainMembership) SetFQDN

func (s *DomainMembership) SetFQDN(v string) *DomainMembership

SetFQDN sets the FQDN field's value.

func (*DomainMembership) SetIAMRoleName

func (s *DomainMembership) SetIAMRoleName(v string) *DomainMembership

SetIAMRoleName sets the IAMRoleName field's value.

func (*DomainMembership) SetStatus

func (s *DomainMembership) SetStatus(v string) *DomainMembership

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (DomainMembership) String

func (s DomainMembership) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DoubleRange

type DoubleRange struct {

	// The minimum value in the range.
	From *float64 `type:"double"`

	// The maximum value in the range.
	To *float64 `type:"double"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

A range of double values.

func (DoubleRange) GoString

func (s DoubleRange) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DoubleRange) SetFrom

func (s *DoubleRange) SetFrom(v float64) *DoubleRange

SetFrom sets the From field's value.

func (*DoubleRange) SetTo

func (s *DoubleRange) SetTo(v float64) *DoubleRange

SetTo sets the To field's value.

func (DoubleRange) String

func (s DoubleRange) String() string

String returns the string representation

type DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput

type DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput struct {

	// The customer-assigned name of the DB instance that contains the log files
	// you want to list.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the log file to be downloaded.
	//
	// LogFileName is a required field
	LogFileName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The pagination token provided in the previous request or "0". If the Marker
	// parameter is specified the response includes only records beyond the marker
	// until the end of the file or up to NumberOfLines.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// The number of lines to download. If the number of lines specified results
	// in a file over 1 MB in size, the file is truncated at 1 MB in size.
	//
	// If the NumberOfLines parameter is specified, then the block of lines returned
	// can be from the beginning or the end of the log file, depending on the value
	// of the Marker parameter.
	//
	//    * If neither Marker or NumberOfLines are specified, the entire log file
	//    is returned up to a maximum of 10000 lines, starting with the most recent
	//    log entries first.
	//
	//    * If NumberOfLines is specified and Marker is not specified, then the
	//    most recent lines from the end of the log file are returned.
	//
	//    * If Marker is specified as "0", then the specified number of lines from
	//    the beginning of the log file are returned.
	//
	//    * You can download the log file in blocks of lines by specifying the size
	//    of the block using the NumberOfLines parameter, and by specifying a value
	//    of "0" for the Marker parameter in your first request. Include the Marker
	//    value returned in the response as the Marker value for the next request,
	//    continuing until the AdditionalDataPending response element returns false.
	NumberOfLines *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetLogFileName

SetLogFileName sets the LogFileName field's value.

func (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) SetNumberOfLines

SetNumberOfLines sets the NumberOfLines field's value.

func (DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) Validate

func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput

type DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput struct {

	// Boolean value that if true, indicates there is more data to be downloaded.
	AdditionalDataPending *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Entries from the specified log file.
	LogFileData *string `type:"string"`

	// A pagination token that can be used in a subsequent DownloadDBLogFilePortion
	// request.
	Marker *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element to DownloadDBLogFilePortion.

func (DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetAdditionalDataPending

func (s *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetAdditionalDataPending(v bool) *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput

SetAdditionalDataPending sets the AdditionalDataPending field's value.

func (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetLogFileData

SetLogFileData sets the LogFileData field's value.

func (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) SetMarker

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type EC2SecurityGroup

type EC2SecurityGroup struct {

	// Specifies the id of the EC2 security group.
	EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the name of the EC2 security group.
	EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the AWS ID of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in
	// the EC2SecurityGroupName field.
	EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the status of the EC2 security group. Status can be "authorizing",
	// "authorized", "revoking", and "revoked".
	Status *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:

  • AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress

  • DescribeDBSecurityGroups

  • RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress

func (EC2SecurityGroup) GoString

func (s EC2SecurityGroup) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupId

func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupId(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup

SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.

func (*EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupName

func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupName(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup

SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId

func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup

SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.

func (*EC2SecurityGroup) SetStatus

func (s *EC2SecurityGroup) SetStatus(v string) *EC2SecurityGroup

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (EC2SecurityGroup) String

func (s EC2SecurityGroup) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Endpoint

type Endpoint struct {

	// Specifies the DNS address of the DB instance.
	Address *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the ID that Amazon Route 53 assigns when you create a hosted zone.
	HostedZoneId *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the port that the database engine is listening on.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the following actions:

  • CreateDBInstance

  • DescribeDBInstances

  • DeleteDBInstance

func (Endpoint) GoString

func (s Endpoint) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Endpoint) SetAddress

func (s *Endpoint) SetAddress(v string) *Endpoint

SetAddress sets the Address field's value.

func (*Endpoint) SetHostedZoneId

func (s *Endpoint) SetHostedZoneId(v string) *Endpoint

SetHostedZoneId sets the HostedZoneId field's value.

func (*Endpoint) SetPort

func (s *Endpoint) SetPort(v int64) *Endpoint

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (Endpoint) String

func (s Endpoint) String() string

String returns the string representation

type EngineDefaults

type EngineDefaults struct {

	// Specifies the name of the DB parameter group family that the engine default
	// parameters apply to.
	DBParameterGroupFamily *string `type:"string"`

	// An optional pagination token provided by a previous EngineDefaults request.
	// If this parameter is specified, the response includes only records beyond
	// the marker, up to the value specified by MaxRecords .
	Marker *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains a list of engine default parameters.
	Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the result of a successful invocation of the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters action.

func (EngineDefaults) GoString

func (s EngineDefaults) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*EngineDefaults) SetDBParameterGroupFamily

func (s *EngineDefaults) SetDBParameterGroupFamily(v string) *EngineDefaults

SetDBParameterGroupFamily sets the DBParameterGroupFamily field's value.

func (*EngineDefaults) SetMarker

func (s *EngineDefaults) SetMarker(v string) *EngineDefaults

SetMarker sets the Marker field's value.

func (*EngineDefaults) SetParameters

func (s *EngineDefaults) SetParameters(v []*Parameter) *EngineDefaults

SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.

func (EngineDefaults) String

func (s EngineDefaults) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Event

type Event struct {

	// Specifies the date and time of the event.
	Date *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Specifies the category for the event.
	EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`

	// Provides the text of this event.
	Message *string `type:"string"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the event.
	SourceArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides the identifier for the source of the event.
	SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the source type for this event.
	SourceType *string `type:"string" enum:"SourceType"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeEvents action.

func (Event) GoString

func (s Event) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Event) SetDate

func (s *Event) SetDate(v time.Time) *Event

SetDate sets the Date field's value.

func (*Event) SetEventCategories

func (s *Event) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *Event

SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.

func (*Event) SetMessage

func (s *Event) SetMessage(v string) *Event

SetMessage sets the Message field's value.

func (*Event) SetSourceArn

func (s *Event) SetSourceArn(v string) *Event

SetSourceArn sets the SourceArn field's value.

func (*Event) SetSourceIdentifier

func (s *Event) SetSourceIdentifier(v string) *Event

SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.

func (*Event) SetSourceType

func (s *Event) SetSourceType(v string) *Event

SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.

func (Event) String

func (s Event) String() string

String returns the string representation

type EventCategoriesMap

type EventCategoriesMap struct {

	// The event categories for the specified source type
	EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`

	// The source type that the returned categories belong to
	SourceType *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventCategories action.

func (EventCategoriesMap) GoString

func (s EventCategoriesMap) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*EventCategoriesMap) SetEventCategories

func (s *EventCategoriesMap) SetEventCategories(v []*string) *EventCategoriesMap

SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.

func (*EventCategoriesMap) SetSourceType

func (s *EventCategoriesMap) SetSourceType(v string) *EventCategoriesMap

SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.

func (EventCategoriesMap) String

func (s EventCategoriesMap) String() string

String returns the string representation

type EventSubscription

type EventSubscription struct {

	// The RDS event notification subscription Id.
	CustSubscriptionId *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS customer account associated with the RDS event notification subscription.
	CustomerAwsId *string `type:"string"`

	// A Boolean value indicating if the subscription is enabled. True indicates
	// the subscription is enabled.
	Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A list of event categories for the RDS event notification subscription.
	EventCategoriesList []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the event subscription.
	EventSubscriptionArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The topic ARN of the RDS event notification subscription.
	SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of source IDs for the RDS event notification subscription.
	SourceIdsList []*string `locationNameList:"SourceId" type:"list"`

	// The source type for the RDS event notification subscription.
	SourceType *string `type:"string"`

	// The status of the RDS event notification subscription.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	// Can be one of the following: creating | modifying | deleting | active | no-permission
	// | topic-not-exist
	//
	// The status "no-permission" indicates that RDS no longer has permission to
	// post to the SNS topic. The status "topic-not-exist" indicates that the topic
	// was deleted after the subscription was created.
	Status *string `type:"string"`

	// The time the RDS event notification subscription was created.
	SubscriptionCreationTime *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions action.

func (EventSubscription) GoString

func (s EventSubscription) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*EventSubscription) SetCustSubscriptionId

func (s *EventSubscription) SetCustSubscriptionId(v string) *EventSubscription

SetCustSubscriptionId sets the CustSubscriptionId field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetCustomerAwsId

func (s *EventSubscription) SetCustomerAwsId(v string) *EventSubscription

SetCustomerAwsId sets the CustomerAwsId field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetEnabled

func (s *EventSubscription) SetEnabled(v bool) *EventSubscription

SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetEventCategoriesList

func (s *EventSubscription) SetEventCategoriesList(v []*string) *EventSubscription

SetEventCategoriesList sets the EventCategoriesList field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetEventSubscriptionArn

func (s *EventSubscription) SetEventSubscriptionArn(v string) *EventSubscription

SetEventSubscriptionArn sets the EventSubscriptionArn field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetSnsTopicArn

func (s *EventSubscription) SetSnsTopicArn(v string) *EventSubscription

SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetSourceIdsList

func (s *EventSubscription) SetSourceIdsList(v []*string) *EventSubscription

SetSourceIdsList sets the SourceIdsList field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetSourceType

func (s *EventSubscription) SetSourceType(v string) *EventSubscription

SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetStatus

func (s *EventSubscription) SetStatus(v string) *EventSubscription

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (*EventSubscription) SetSubscriptionCreationTime

func (s *EventSubscription) SetSubscriptionCreationTime(v string) *EventSubscription

SetSubscriptionCreationTime sets the SubscriptionCreationTime field's value.

func (EventSubscription) String

func (s EventSubscription) String() string

String returns the string representation

type FailoverDBClusterInput

type FailoverDBClusterInput struct {

	// A DB cluster identifier to force a failover for. This parameter is not case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the instance to promote to the primary instance.
	//
	// You must specify the instance identifier for an Aurora Replica in the DB
	// cluster. For example, mydbcluster-replica1.
	TargetDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (FailoverDBClusterInput) GoString

func (s FailoverDBClusterInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*FailoverDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *FailoverDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *FailoverDBClusterInput

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*FailoverDBClusterInput) SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *FailoverDBClusterInput) SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *FailoverDBClusterInput

SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the TargetDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (FailoverDBClusterInput) String

func (s FailoverDBClusterInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type FailoverDBClusterOutput

type FailoverDBClusterOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
	DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (FailoverDBClusterOutput) GoString

func (s FailoverDBClusterOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*FailoverDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster

SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.

func (FailoverDBClusterOutput) String

func (s FailoverDBClusterOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Filter

type Filter struct {

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	//
	// Name is a required field
	Name *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	//
	// Values is a required field
	Values []*string `locationNameList:"Value" type:"list" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This type is not currently supported.

func (Filter) GoString

func (s Filter) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Filter) SetName

func (s *Filter) SetName(v string) *Filter

SetName sets the Name field's value.

func (*Filter) SetValues

func (s *Filter) SetValues(v []*string) *Filter

SetValues sets the Values field's value.

func (Filter) String

func (s Filter) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*Filter) Validate

func (s *Filter) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type IPRange

type IPRange struct {

	// Specifies the IP range.
	CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the status of the IP range. Status can be "authorizing", "authorized",
	// "revoking", and "revoked".
	Status *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups action.

func (IPRange) GoString

func (s IPRange) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*IPRange) SetCIDRIP

func (s *IPRange) SetCIDRIP(v string) *IPRange

SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.

func (*IPRange) SetStatus

func (s *IPRange) SetStatus(v string) *IPRange

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (IPRange) String

func (s IPRange) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ListTagsForResourceInput

type ListTagsForResourceInput struct {

	// This parameter is not currently supported.
	Filters []*Filter `locationNameList:"Filter" type:"list"`

	// The Amazon RDS resource with tags to be listed. This value is an Amazon Resource
	// Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see  Constructing an RDS
	// Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
	//
	// ResourceName is a required field
	ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ListTagsForResourceInput) GoString

func (s ListTagsForResourceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ListTagsForResourceInput) SetFilters

SetFilters sets the Filters field's value.

func (*ListTagsForResourceInput) SetResourceName

SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.

func (ListTagsForResourceInput) String

func (s ListTagsForResourceInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*ListTagsForResourceInput) Validate

func (s *ListTagsForResourceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ListTagsForResourceOutput

type ListTagsForResourceOutput struct {

	// List of tags returned by the ListTagsForResource operation.
	TagList []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ListTagsForResourceOutput) GoString

func (s ListTagsForResourceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ListTagsForResourceOutput) SetTagList

SetTagList sets the TagList field's value.

func (ListTagsForResourceOutput) String

func (s ListTagsForResourceOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ModifyDBClusterInput

type ModifyDBClusterInput struct {

	// A value that specifies whether the modifications in this request and any
	// pending modifications are asynchronously applied as soon as possible, regardless
	// of the PreferredMaintenanceWindow setting for the DB cluster. If this parameter
	// is set to false, changes to the DB cluster are applied during the next maintenance
	// window.
	//
	// The ApplyImmediately parameter only affects the NewDBClusterIdentifier and
	// MasterUserPassword values. If you set the ApplyImmediately parameter value
	// to false, then changes to the NewDBClusterIdentifier and MasterUserPassword
	// values are applied during the next maintenance window. All other changes
	// are applied immediately, regardless of the value of the ApplyImmediately
	// parameter.
	//
	// Default: false
	ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. You must specify
	// a minimum value of 1.
	//
	// Default: 1
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be a value from 1 to 35
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The DB cluster identifier for the cluster being modified. This parameter
	// is not case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to use for the DB cluster.
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The version number of the database engine to which you want to upgrade. Changing
	// this parameter results in an outage. The change is applied during the next
	// maintenance window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true.
	//
	// For a list of valid engine versions, see CreateDBInstance, or call DescribeDBEngineVersions.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The new password for the master database user. This password can contain
	// any printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
	MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// The new DB cluster identifier for the DB cluster when renaming a DB cluster.
	// This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * The first character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: my-cluster2
	NewDBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// A value that indicates that the DB cluster should be associated with the
	// specified option group. Changing this parameter doesn't result in an outage
	// except in the following case, and the change is applied during the next maintenance
	// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
	// If the parameter change results in an option group that enables OEM, this
	// change can cause a brief (sub-second) period during which new connections
	// are rejected but existing connections are not interrupted.
	//
	// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. The option group
	// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the DB cluster accepts connections.
	//
	// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
	//
	// Default: The same port as the original DB cluster.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
	// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see  Adjusting
	// the Preferred Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
	//
	//    * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	//    * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
	//
	//    * Must be at least 30 minutes.
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
	// Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
	// the time blocks available, see  Adjusting the Preferred Maintenance Window
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
	PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of VPC security groups that the DB cluster will belong to.
	VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBClusterInput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBClusterInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetApplyImmediately

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetEngineVersion

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetNewDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetNewDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetNewDBClusterIdentifier sets the NewDBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *ModifyDBClusterInput

SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.

func (ModifyDBClusterInput) String

func (s ModifyDBClusterInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBClusterInput) Validate

func (s *ModifyDBClusterInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyDBClusterOutput

type ModifyDBClusterOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
	DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBClusterOutput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBClusterOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster

SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.

func (ModifyDBClusterOutput) String

func (s ModifyDBClusterOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput

type ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to modify.
	//
	// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of parameters in the DB cluster parameter group to modify.
	//
	// Parameters is a required field
	Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameters

SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.

func (ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput

type ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster snapshot attribute to modify.
	//
	// To manage authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
	// DB cluster snapshot, set this value to restore.
	//
	// AttributeName is a required field
	AttributeName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The identifier for the DB cluster snapshot to modify the attributes for.
	//
	// DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of DB cluster snapshot attributes to add to the attribute specified
	// by AttributeName.
	//
	// To authorize other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot,
	// set this list to include one or more AWS account IDs, or all to make the
	// manual DB cluster snapshot restorable by any AWS account. Do not add the
	// all value for any manual DB cluster snapshots that contain private information
	// that you don't want available to all AWS accounts.
	ValuesToAdd []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`

	// A list of DB cluster snapshot attributes to remove from the attribute specified
	// by AttributeName.
	//
	// To remove authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
	// DB cluster snapshot, set this list to include one or more AWS account identifiers,
	// or all to remove authorization for any AWS account to copy or restore the
	// DB cluster snapshot. If you specify all, an AWS account whose account ID
	// is explicitly added to the restore attribute can still copy or restore a
	// manual DB cluster snapshot.
	ValuesToRemove []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetAttributeName

SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier

SetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToAdd

SetValuesToAdd sets the ValuesToAdd field's value.

func (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToRemove

SetValuesToRemove sets the ValuesToRemove field's value.

func (ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput

type ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes
	// API action.
	//
	// Manual DB cluster snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts
	// to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot. For more information, see
	// the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.
	DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult *DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult

SetDBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBClusterSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.

func (ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type ModifyDBInstanceInput

type ModifyDBInstanceInput struct {

	// The new amount of storage (in gibibytes) to allocate for the DB instance.
	//
	// For MariaDB, MySQL, Oracle, and PostgreSQL, the value supplied must be at
	// least 10% greater than the current value. Values that are not at least 10%
	// greater than the existing value are rounded up so that they are 10% greater
	// than the current value.
	//
	// For the valid values for allocated storage for each engine, see CreateDBInstance.
	AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Indicates that major version upgrades are allowed. Changing this parameter
	// doesn't result in an outage and the change is asynchronously applied as soon
	// as possible.
	//
	// Constraints: This parameter must be set to true when specifying a value for
	// the EngineVersion parameter that is a different major version than the DB
	// instance's current version.
	AllowMajorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies whether the modifications in this request and any pending modifications
	// are asynchronously applied as soon as possible, regardless of the PreferredMaintenanceWindow
	// setting for the DB instance.
	//
	// If this parameter is set to false, changes to the DB instance are applied
	// during the next maintenance window. Some parameter changes can cause an outage
	// and are applied on the next call to RebootDBInstance, or the next failure
	// reboot. Review the table of parameters in Modifying a DB Instance and Using
	// the Apply Immediately Parameter (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.DBInstance.Modifying.html)
	// to see the impact that setting ApplyImmediately to true or false has for
	// each modified parameter and to determine when the changes are applied.
	//
	// Default: false
	ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
	// instance during the maintenance window. Changing this parameter doesn't result
	// in an outage except in the following case and the change is asynchronously
	// applied as soon as possible. An outage will result if this parameter is set
	// to true during the maintenance window, and a newer minor version is available,
	// and RDS has enabled auto patching for that engine version.
	AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The number of days to retain automated backups. Setting this parameter to
	// a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to 0 disables automated
	// backups.
	//
	// Changing this parameter can result in an outage if you change from 0 to a
	// non-zero value or from a non-zero value to 0. These changes are applied during
	// the next maintenance window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set
	// to true for this request. If you change the parameter from one non-zero value
	// to another non-zero value, the change is asynchronously applied as soon as
	// possible.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The retention period for automated backups is managed by
	// the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
	//
	// Default: Uses existing setting
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be a value from 0 to 35
	//
	//    * Can be specified for a MySQL Read Replica only if the source is running
	//    MySQL 5.6
	//
	//    * Can be specified for a PostgreSQL Read Replica only if the source is
	//    running PostgreSQL 9.3.5
	//
	//    * Cannot be set to 0 if the DB instance is a source to Read Replicas
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Indicates the certificate that needs to be associated with the instance.
	CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The configuration setting for the log types to be enabled for export to CloudWatch
	// Logs for a specific DB instance or DB cluster.
	CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration `type:"structure"`

	// True to copy all tags from the DB instance to snapshots of the DB instance,
	// and otherwise false. The default is false.
	CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The new compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
	// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
	// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
	// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// If you modify the DB instance class, an outage occurs during the change.
	// The change is applied during the next maintenance window, unless ApplyImmediately
	// is specified as true for this request.
	//
	// Default: Uses existing setting
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB instance identifier. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the DB parameter group to apply to the DB instance. Changing
	// this setting doesn't result in an outage. The parameter group name itself
	// is changed immediately, but the actual parameter changes are not applied
	// until you reboot the instance without failover. The db instance will NOT
	// be rebooted automatically and the parameter changes will NOT be applied during
	// the next maintenance window.
	//
	// Default: Uses existing setting
	//
	// Constraints: The DB parameter group must be in the same DB parameter group
	// family as this DB instance.
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
	//
	// The value of the DBPortNumber parameter must not match any of the port values
	// specified for options in the option group for the DB instance.
	//
	// Your database will restart when you change the DBPortNumber value regardless
	// of the value of the ApplyImmediately parameter.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	// Default: 3306
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	// Default: 3306
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// PostgreSQL
	//
	// Default: 5432
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// Type: Integer
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// Default: 1521
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// SQL Server
	//
	// Default: 1433
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535 except for 1434, 3389, 47001, 49152, and 49152 through
	// 49156.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Default: 3306
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	DBPortNumber *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// A list of DB security groups to authorize on this DB instance. Changing this
	// setting doesn't result in an outage and the change is asynchronously applied
	// as soon as possible.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match existing DBSecurityGroups.
	DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`

	// The new DB subnet group for the DB instance. You can use this parameter to
	// move your DB instance to a different VPC. If your DB instance is not in a
	// VPC, you can also use this parameter to move your DB instance into a VPC.
	// For more information, see Updating the VPC for a DB Instance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_VPC.WorkingWithRDSInstanceinaVPC.html#USER_VPC.Non-VPC2VPC).
	//
	// Changing the subnet group causes an outage during the change. The change
	// is applied during the next maintenance window, unless you specify true for
	// the ApplyImmediately parameter.
	//
	// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetGroup
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The Active Directory Domain to move the instance to. Specify none to remove
	// the instance from its current domain. The domain must be created prior to
	// this operation. Currently only a Microsoft SQL Server instance can be created
	// in a Active Directory Domain.
	Domain *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the IAM role to use when making API calls to the Directory Service.
	DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. Mapping AWS IAM accounts to database accounts is managed
	// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
	EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The version number of the database engine to upgrade to. Changing this parameter
	// results in an outage and the change is applied during the next maintenance
	// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
	//
	// For major version upgrades, if a nondefault DB parameter group is currently
	// in use, a new DB parameter group in the DB parameter group family for the
	// new engine version must be specified. The new DB parameter group can be the
	// default for that DB parameter group family.
	//
	// For a list of valid engine versions, see CreateDBInstance.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The new Provisioned IOPS (I/O operations per second) value for the RDS instance.
	//
	// Changing this setting doesn't result in an outage and the change is applied
	// during the next maintenance window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter
	// is set to true for this request. If you are migrating from Provisioned IOPS
	// to standard storage, set this value to 0. The DB instance will require a
	// reboot for the change in storage type to take effect.
	//
	// If you choose to migrate your DB instance from using standard storage to
	// using Provisioned IOPS, or from using Provisioned IOPS to using standard
	// storage, the process can take time. The duration of the migration depends
	// on several factors such as database load, storage size, storage type (standard
	// or Provisioned IOPS), amount of IOPS provisioned (if any), and the number
	// of prior scale storage operations. Typical migration times are under 24 hours,
	// but the process can take up to several days in some cases. During the migration,
	// the DB instance is available for use, but might experience performance degradation.
	// While the migration takes place, nightly backups for the instance are suspended.
	// No other Amazon RDS operations can take place for the instance, including
	// modifying the instance, rebooting the instance, deleting the instance, creating
	// a Read Replica for the instance, and creating a DB snapshot of the instance.
	//
	// Constraints: For MariaDB, MySQL, Oracle, and PostgreSQL, the value supplied
	// must be at least 10% greater than the current value. Values that are not
	// at least 10% greater than the existing value are rounded up so that they
	// are 10% greater than the current value.
	//
	// Default: Uses existing setting
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The license model for the DB instance.
	//
	// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// The new password for the master user. The password can include any printable
	// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
	//
	// Changing this parameter doesn't result in an outage and the change is asynchronously
	// applied as soon as possible. Between the time of the request and the completion
	// of the request, the MasterUserPassword element exists in the PendingModifiedValues
	// element of the operation response.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The password for the master user is managed by the DB cluster.
	// For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
	//
	// Default: Uses existing setting
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
	//
	// Microsoft SQL Server
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 30 characters.
	//
	// PostgreSQL
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 128 characters.
	//
	// Amazon RDS API actions never return the password, so this action provides
	// a way to regain access to a primary instance user if the password is lost.
	// This includes restoring privileges that might have been accidentally revoked.
	MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
	// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
	// metrics, specify 0. The default is 0.
	//
	// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
	// to a value other than 0.
	//
	// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
	MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
	// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
	// For information on creating a monitoring role, go to To create an IAM role
	// for Amazon RDS Enhanced Monitoring (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.IAMRole).
	//
	// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
	// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
	MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment. Changing this parameter
	// doesn't result in an outage and the change is applied during the next maintenance
	// window unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The new DB instance identifier for the DB instance when renaming a DB instance.
	// When you change the DB instance identifier, an instance reboot will occur
	// immediately if you set Apply Immediately to true, or will occur during the
	// next maintenance window if Apply Immediately to false. This value is stored
	// as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * The first character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	//
	// Example: mydbinstance
	NewDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates that the DB instance should be associated with the specified option
	// group. Changing this parameter doesn't result in an outage except in the
	// following case and the change is applied during the next maintenance window
	// unless the ApplyImmediately parameter is set to true for this request. If
	// the parameter change results in an option group that enables OEM, this change
	// can cause a brief (sub-second) period during which new connections are rejected
	// but existing connections are not interrupted.
	//
	// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
	// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
	// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
	// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), KMS key identifier, or the
	// KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
	PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
	// backups are enabled, as determined by the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
	// Changing this parameter doesn't result in an outage and the change is asynchronously
	// applied as soon as possible.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The daily time range for creating automated backups is managed
	// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi
	//
	//    * Must be in Universal Time Coordinated (UTC)
	//
	//    * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window
	//
	//    * Must be at least 30 minutes
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// The weekly time range (in UTC) during which system maintenance can occur,
	// which might result in an outage. Changing this parameter doesn't result in
	// an outage, except in the following situation, and the change is asynchronously
	// applied as soon as possible. If there are pending actions that cause a reboot,
	// and the maintenance window is changed to include the current time, then changing
	// this parameter will cause a reboot of the DB instance. If moving this window
	// to the current time, there must be at least 30 minutes between the current
	// time and end of the window to ensure pending changes are applied.
	//
	// Default: Uses existing setting
	//
	// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
	//
	// Valid Days: Mon | Tue | Wed | Thu | Fri | Sat | Sun
	//
	// Constraints: Must be at least 30 minutes
	PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// A value that specifies the order in which an Aurora Replica is promoted to
	// the primary instance after a failure of the existing primary instance. For
	// more information, see  Fault Tolerance for an Aurora DB Cluster (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Managing.html#Aurora.Managing.FaultTolerance).
	//
	// Default: 1
	//
	// Valid Values: 0 - 15
	PromotionTier *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Boolean value that indicates if the DB instance has a publicly resolvable
	// DNS name. Set to True to make the DB instance Internet-facing with a publicly
	// resolvable DNS name, which resolves to a public IP address. Set to False
	// to make the DB instance internal with a DNS name that resolves to a private
	// IP address.
	//
	// PubliclyAccessible only applies to DB instances in a VPC. The DB instance
	// must be part of a public subnet and PubliclyAccessible must be true in order
	// for it to be publicly accessible.
	//
	// Changes to the PubliclyAccessible parameter are applied immediately regardless
	// of the value of the ApplyImmediately parameter.
	//
	// Default: false
	PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
	//
	// If you specify Provisioned IOPS (io1), you must also include a value for
	// the Iops parameter.
	//
	// If you choose to migrate your DB instance from using standard storage to
	// using Provisioned IOPS, or from using Provisioned IOPS to using standard
	// storage, the process can take time. The duration of the migration depends
	// on several factors such as database load, storage size, storage type (standard
	// or Provisioned IOPS), amount of IOPS provisioned (if any), and the number
	// of prior scale storage operations. Typical migration times are under 24 hours,
	// but the process can take up to several days in some cases. During the migration,
	// the DB instance is available for use, but might experience performance degradation.
	// While the migration takes place, nightly backups for the instance are suspended.
	// No other Amazon RDS operations can take place for the instance, including
	// modifying the instance, rebooting the instance, deleting the instance, creating
	// a Read Replica for the instance, and creating a DB snapshot of the instance.
	//
	// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
	//
	// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
	TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
	// device.
	TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to authorize on this DB instance. This
	// change is asynchronously applied as soon as possible.
	//
	// Amazon Aurora
	//
	// Not applicable. The associated list of EC2 VPC security groups is managed
	// by the DB cluster. For more information, see ModifyDBCluster.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match existing VpcSecurityGroupIds.
	VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBInstanceInput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBInstanceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAllocatedStorage

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAllowMajorVersionUpgrade

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAllowMajorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetAllowMajorVersionUpgrade sets the AllowMajorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetApplyImmediately

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCACertificateIdentifier

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration(v *CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetCloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration sets the CloudwatchLogsExportConfiguration field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceClass

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBPortNumber

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBPortNumber(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetDBPortNumber sets the DBPortNumber field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBSecurityGroups

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBSecurityGroups(v []*string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDomain

SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEngineVersion

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetIops

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetLicenseModel

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetLicenseModel(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUserPassword

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringInterval

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringInterval(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMonitoringRoleArn(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetNewDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetNewDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetNewDBInstanceIdentifier sets the NewDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPromotionTier

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPromotionTier(v int64) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetPromotionTier sets the PromotionTier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPubliclyAccessible

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetStorageType

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetStorageType(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialArn

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialArn(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword(v string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *ModifyDBInstanceInput

SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.

func (ModifyDBInstanceInput) String

func (s ModifyDBInstanceInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBInstanceInput) Validate

func (s *ModifyDBInstanceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyDBInstanceOutput

type ModifyDBInstanceOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBInstanceOutput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (ModifyDBInstanceOutput) String

func (s ModifyDBInstanceOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ModifyDBParameterGroupInput

type ModifyDBParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the DB parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
	//
	// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// An array of parameter names, values, and the apply method for the parameter
	// update. At least one parameter name, value, and apply method must be supplied;
	// subsequent arguments are optional. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified
	// in a single request.
	//
	// Valid Values (for the application method): immediate | pending-reboot
	//
	// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
	// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
	// are applied when you reboot the DB instance without failover.
	//
	// Parameters is a required field
	Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) SetParameters

SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.

func (ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) Validate

func (s *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput

type ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput struct {

	// The name of the DB snapshot attribute to modify.
	//
	// To manage authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
	// DB snapshot, set this value to restore.
	//
	// AttributeName is a required field
	AttributeName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The identifier for the DB snapshot to modify the attributes for.
	//
	// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of DB snapshot attributes to add to the attribute specified by AttributeName.
	//
	// To authorize other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual snapshot, set
	// this list to include one or more AWS account IDs, or all to make the manual
	// DB snapshot restorable by any AWS account. Do not add the all value for any
	// manual DB snapshots that contain private information that you don't want
	// available to all AWS accounts.
	ValuesToAdd []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`

	// A list of DB snapshot attributes to remove from the attribute specified by
	// AttributeName.
	//
	// To remove authorization for other AWS accounts to copy or restore a manual
	// snapshot, set this list to include one or more AWS account identifiers, or
	// all to remove authorization for any AWS account to copy or restore the DB
	// snapshot. If you specify all, an AWS account whose account ID is explicitly
	// added to the restore attribute can still copy or restore the manual DB snapshot.
	ValuesToRemove []*string `locationNameList:"AttributeValue" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetAttributeName

SetAttributeName sets the AttributeName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToAdd

SetValuesToAdd sets the ValuesToAdd field's value.

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) SetValuesToRemove

SetValuesToRemove sets the ValuesToRemove field's value.

func (ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) Validate

func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput

type ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful call to the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes
	// API action.
	//
	// Manual DB snapshot attributes are used to authorize other AWS accounts to
	// copy or restore a manual DB snapshot. For more information, see the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute
	// API action.
	DBSnapshotAttributesResult *DBSnapshotAttributesResult `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult

SetDBSnapshotAttributesResult sets the DBSnapshotAttributesResult field's value.

func (ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type ModifyDBSnapshotInput

type ModifyDBSnapshotInput struct {

	// The identifier of the DB snapshot to modify.
	//
	// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The engine version to upgrade the DB snapshot to.
	//
	// The following are the database engines and engine versions that are available
	// when you upgrade a DB snapshot.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	//    * 5.5.46 (supported for 5.1 DB snapshots)
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	//    * 12.1.0.2.v8 (supported for 12.1.0.1 DB snapshots)
	//
	//    * 11.2.0.4.v12 (supported for 11.2.0.2 DB snapshots)
	//
	//    * 11.2.0.4.v11 (supported for 11.2.0.3 DB snapshots)
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The option group to identify with the upgraded DB snapshot.
	//
	// You can specify this parameter when you upgrade an Oracle DB snapshot. The
	// same option group considerations apply when upgrading a DB snapshot as when
	// upgrading a DB instance. For more information, see Option Group Considerations
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Oracle.html#USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Oracle.OGPG.OG).
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBSnapshotInput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBSnapshotInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetEngineVersion

func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetEngineVersion(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBSnapshotInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (ModifyDBSnapshotInput) String

func (s ModifyDBSnapshotInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotInput) Validate

func (s *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyDBSnapshotOutput

type ModifyDBSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB snapshot.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSnapshots action.
	DBSnapshot *DBSnapshot `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBSnapshot

SetDBSnapshot sets the DBSnapshot field's value.

func (ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) String

func (s ModifyDBSnapshotOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput

type ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput struct {

	// The description for the DB subnet group.
	DBSubnetGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The name for the DB subnet group. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	// You can't modify the default subnet group.
	//
	// Constraints: Must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup. Must not be
	// default.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	//
	// DBSubnetGroupName is a required field
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The EC2 subnet IDs for the DB subnet group.
	//
	// SubnetIds is a required field
	SubnetIds []*string `locationNameList:"SubnetIdentifier" type:"list" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription

func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupDescription(v string) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput

SetDBSubnetGroupDescription sets the DBSubnetGroupDescription field's value.

func (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) SetSubnetIds

SetSubnetIds sets the SubnetIds field's value.

func (ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) String

func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate

func (s *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput

type ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB subnet group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups
	// action.
	DBSubnetGroup *DBSubnetGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString

func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) SetDBSubnetGroup

SetDBSubnetGroup sets the DBSubnetGroup field's value.

func (ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) String

func (s ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ModifyEventSubscriptionInput

type ModifyEventSubscriptionInput struct {

	// A Boolean value; set to true to activate the subscription.
	Enabled *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A list of event categories for a SourceType that you want to subscribe to.
	// You can see a list of the categories for a given SourceType in the Events
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html)
	// topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories
	// action.
	EventCategories []*string `locationNameList:"EventCategory" type:"list"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the SNS topic created for event notification.
	// The ARN is created by Amazon SNS when you create a topic and subscribe to
	// it.
	SnsTopicArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The type of source that is generating the events. For example, if you want
	// to be notified of events generated by a DB instance, you would set this parameter
	// to db-instance. if this value is not specified, all events are returned.
	//
	// Valid values: db-instance | db-parameter-group | db-security-group | db-snapshot
	SourceType *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the RDS event notification subscription.
	//
	// SubscriptionName is a required field
	SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) GoString

func (s ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetEnabled

SetEnabled sets the Enabled field's value.

func (*ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetEventCategories

SetEventCategories sets the EventCategories field's value.

func (*ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSnsTopicArn

SetSnsTopicArn sets the SnsTopicArn field's value.

func (*ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSourceType

SetSourceType sets the SourceType field's value.

func (*ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName

SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.

func (ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) Validate

func (s *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput

type ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
	// action.
	EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription

SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.

func (ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type ModifyOptionGroupInput

type ModifyOptionGroupInput struct {

	// Indicates whether the changes should be applied immediately, or during the
	// next maintenance window for each instance associated with the option group.
	ApplyImmediately *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the option group to be modified.
	//
	// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
	// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
	// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
	//
	// OptionGroupName is a required field
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Options in this list are added to the option group or, if already present,
	// the specified configuration is used to update the existing configuration.
	OptionsToInclude []*OptionConfiguration `locationNameList:"OptionConfiguration" type:"list"`

	// Options in this list are removed from the option group.
	OptionsToRemove []*string `type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyOptionGroupInput) GoString

func (s ModifyOptionGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetApplyImmediately

func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetApplyImmediately(v bool) *ModifyOptionGroupInput

SetApplyImmediately sets the ApplyImmediately field's value.

func (*ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *ModifyOptionGroupInput

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionsToInclude

SetOptionsToInclude sets the OptionsToInclude field's value.

func (*ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionsToRemove

func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) SetOptionsToRemove(v []*string) *ModifyOptionGroupInput

SetOptionsToRemove sets the OptionsToRemove field's value.

func (ModifyOptionGroupInput) String

func (s ModifyOptionGroupInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*ModifyOptionGroupInput) Validate

func (s *ModifyOptionGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ModifyOptionGroupOutput

type ModifyOptionGroupOutput struct {
	OptionGroup *OptionGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ModifyOptionGroupOutput) GoString

func (s ModifyOptionGroupOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ModifyOptionGroupOutput) SetOptionGroup

SetOptionGroup sets the OptionGroup field's value.

func (ModifyOptionGroupOutput) String

func (s ModifyOptionGroupOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Option

type Option struct {

	// If the option requires access to a port, then this DB security group allows
	// access to the port.
	DBSecurityGroupMemberships []*DBSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroup" type:"list"`

	// The description of the option.
	OptionDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the option.
	OptionName *string `type:"string"`

	// The option settings for this option.
	OptionSettings []*OptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionSetting" type:"list"`

	// The version of the option.
	OptionVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicate if this option is permanent.
	Permanent *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicate if this option is persistent.
	Persistent *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// If required, the port configured for this option to use.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// If the option requires access to a port, then this VPC security group allows
	// access to the port.
	VpcSecurityGroupMemberships []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupMembership" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Option details.

func (Option) GoString

func (s Option) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Option) SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships

func (s *Option) SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*DBSecurityGroupMembership) *Option

SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships sets the DBSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.

func (*Option) SetOptionDescription

func (s *Option) SetOptionDescription(v string) *Option

SetOptionDescription sets the OptionDescription field's value.

func (*Option) SetOptionName

func (s *Option) SetOptionName(v string) *Option

SetOptionName sets the OptionName field's value.

func (*Option) SetOptionSettings

func (s *Option) SetOptionSettings(v []*OptionSetting) *Option

SetOptionSettings sets the OptionSettings field's value.

func (*Option) SetOptionVersion

func (s *Option) SetOptionVersion(v string) *Option

SetOptionVersion sets the OptionVersion field's value.

func (*Option) SetPermanent

func (s *Option) SetPermanent(v bool) *Option

SetPermanent sets the Permanent field's value.

func (*Option) SetPersistent

func (s *Option) SetPersistent(v bool) *Option

SetPersistent sets the Persistent field's value.

func (*Option) SetPort

func (s *Option) SetPort(v int64) *Option

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*Option) SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships

func (s *Option) SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) *Option

SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships sets the VpcSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.

func (Option) String

func (s Option) String() string

String returns the string representation

type OptionConfiguration

type OptionConfiguration struct {

	// A list of DBSecurityGroupMemebrship name strings used for this option.
	DBSecurityGroupMemberships []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`

	// The configuration of options to include in a group.
	//
	// OptionName is a required field
	OptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The option settings to include in an option group.
	OptionSettings []*OptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionSetting" type:"list"`

	// The version for the option.
	OptionVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The optional port for the option.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// A list of VpcSecurityGroupMemebrship name strings used for this option.
	VpcSecurityGroupMemberships []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

A list of all available options

func (OptionConfiguration) GoString

func (s OptionConfiguration) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*OptionConfiguration) SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships

func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*string) *OptionConfiguration

SetDBSecurityGroupMemberships sets the DBSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.

func (*OptionConfiguration) SetOptionName

func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionName(v string) *OptionConfiguration

SetOptionName sets the OptionName field's value.

func (*OptionConfiguration) SetOptionSettings

func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionSettings(v []*OptionSetting) *OptionConfiguration

SetOptionSettings sets the OptionSettings field's value.

func (*OptionConfiguration) SetOptionVersion

func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetOptionVersion(v string) *OptionConfiguration

SetOptionVersion sets the OptionVersion field's value.

func (*OptionConfiguration) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*OptionConfiguration) SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships

func (s *OptionConfiguration) SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships(v []*string) *OptionConfiguration

SetVpcSecurityGroupMemberships sets the VpcSecurityGroupMemberships field's value.

func (OptionConfiguration) String

func (s OptionConfiguration) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*OptionConfiguration) Validate

func (s *OptionConfiguration) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type OptionGroup

type OptionGroup struct {

	// Indicates whether this option group can be applied to both VPC and non-VPC
	// instances. The value true indicates the option group can be applied to both
	// VPC and non-VPC instances.
	AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates the name of the engine that this option group can be applied to.
	EngineName *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates the major engine version associated with this option group.
	MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the option group.
	OptionGroupArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides a description of the option group.
	OptionGroupDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the name of the option group.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates what options are available in the option group.
	Options []*Option `locationNameList:"Option" type:"list"`

	// If AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships is false, this field is blank. If
	// AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships is true and this field is blank, then
	// this option group can be applied to both VPC and non-VPC instances. If this
	// field contains a value, then this option group can only be applied to instances
	// that are in the VPC indicated by this field.
	VpcId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (OptionGroup) GoString

func (s OptionGroup) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*OptionGroup) SetAllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships

func (s *OptionGroup) SetAllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships(v bool) *OptionGroup

SetAllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships sets the AllowsVpcAndNonVpcInstanceMemberships field's value.

func (*OptionGroup) SetEngineName

func (s *OptionGroup) SetEngineName(v string) *OptionGroup

SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.

func (*OptionGroup) SetMajorEngineVersion

func (s *OptionGroup) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroup

SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.

func (*OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupArn

func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupArn(v string) *OptionGroup

SetOptionGroupArn sets the OptionGroupArn field's value.

func (*OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupDescription

func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupDescription(v string) *OptionGroup

SetOptionGroupDescription sets the OptionGroupDescription field's value.

func (*OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *OptionGroup

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*OptionGroup) SetOptions

func (s *OptionGroup) SetOptions(v []*Option) *OptionGroup

SetOptions sets the Options field's value.

func (*OptionGroup) SetVpcId

func (s *OptionGroup) SetVpcId(v string) *OptionGroup

SetVpcId sets the VpcId field's value.

func (OptionGroup) String

func (s OptionGroup) String() string

String returns the string representation

type OptionGroupMembership

type OptionGroupMembership struct {

	// The name of the option group that the instance belongs to.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The status of the DB instance's option group membership. Valid values are:
	// in-sync, pending-apply, pending-removal, pending-maintenance-apply, pending-maintenance-removal,
	// applying, removing, and failed.
	Status *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Provides information on the option groups the DB instance is a member of.

func (OptionGroupMembership) GoString

func (s OptionGroupMembership) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*OptionGroupMembership) SetOptionGroupName

func (s *OptionGroupMembership) SetOptionGroupName(v string) *OptionGroupMembership

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*OptionGroupMembership) SetStatus

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (OptionGroupMembership) String

func (s OptionGroupMembership) String() string

String returns the string representation

type OptionGroupOption

type OptionGroupOption struct {

	// If the option requires a port, specifies the default port for the option.
	DefaultPort *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The description of the option.
	Description *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the engine that this option can be applied to.
	EngineName *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates the major engine version that the option is available for.
	MajorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The minimum required engine version for the option to be applied.
	MinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the option.
	Name *string `type:"string"`

	// The option settings that are available (and the default value) for each option
	// in an option group.
	OptionGroupOptionSettings []*OptionGroupOptionSetting `locationNameList:"OptionGroupOptionSetting" type:"list"`

	// The versions that are available for the option.
	OptionGroupOptionVersions []*OptionVersion `locationNameList:"OptionVersion" type:"list"`

	// The options that conflict with this option.
	OptionsConflictsWith []*string `locationNameList:"OptionConflictName" type:"list"`

	// The options that are prerequisites for this option.
	OptionsDependedOn []*string `locationNameList:"OptionName" type:"list"`

	// Permanent options can never be removed from an option group. An option group
	// containing a permanent option can't be removed from a DB instance.
	Permanent *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Persistent options can't be removed from an option group while DB instances
	// are associated with the option group. If you disassociate all DB instances
	// from the option group, your can remove the persistent option from the option
	// group.
	Persistent *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies whether the option requires a port.
	PortRequired *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// If true, you must enable the Auto Minor Version Upgrade setting for your
	// DB instance before you can use this option. You can enable Auto Minor Version
	// Upgrade when you first create your DB instance, or by modifying your DB instance
	// later.
	RequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// If true, you can change the option to an earlier version of the option. This
	// only applies to options that have different versions available.
	SupportsOptionVersionDowngrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// If true, you can only use this option with a DB instance that is in a VPC.
	VpcOnly *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Available option.

func (OptionGroupOption) GoString

func (s OptionGroupOption) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetDefaultPort

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetDefaultPort(v int64) *OptionGroupOption

SetDefaultPort sets the DefaultPort field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetDescription

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetDescription(v string) *OptionGroupOption

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetEngineName

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetEngineName(v string) *OptionGroupOption

SetEngineName sets the EngineName field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetMajorEngineVersion

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetMajorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroupOption

SetMajorEngineVersion sets the MajorEngineVersion field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetMinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetMinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion(v string) *OptionGroupOption

SetMinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion sets the MinimumRequiredMinorEngineVersion field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetName

SetName sets the Name field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetOptionGroupOptionSettings

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionGroupOptionSettings(v []*OptionGroupOptionSetting) *OptionGroupOption

SetOptionGroupOptionSettings sets the OptionGroupOptionSettings field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetOptionGroupOptionVersions

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionGroupOptionVersions(v []*OptionVersion) *OptionGroupOption

SetOptionGroupOptionVersions sets the OptionGroupOptionVersions field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetOptionsConflictsWith

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionsConflictsWith(v []*string) *OptionGroupOption

SetOptionsConflictsWith sets the OptionsConflictsWith field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetOptionsDependedOn

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetOptionsDependedOn(v []*string) *OptionGroupOption

SetOptionsDependedOn sets the OptionsDependedOn field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetPermanent

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPermanent(v bool) *OptionGroupOption

SetPermanent sets the Permanent field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetPersistent

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPersistent(v bool) *OptionGroupOption

SetPersistent sets the Persistent field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetPortRequired

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetPortRequired(v bool) *OptionGroupOption

SetPortRequired sets the PortRequired field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetRequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetRequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade(v bool) *OptionGroupOption

SetRequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade sets the RequiresAutoMinorEngineVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetSupportsOptionVersionDowngrade

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetSupportsOptionVersionDowngrade(v bool) *OptionGroupOption

SetSupportsOptionVersionDowngrade sets the SupportsOptionVersionDowngrade field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOption) SetVpcOnly

func (s *OptionGroupOption) SetVpcOnly(v bool) *OptionGroupOption

SetVpcOnly sets the VpcOnly field's value.

func (OptionGroupOption) String

func (s OptionGroupOption) String() string

String returns the string representation

type OptionGroupOptionSetting

type OptionGroupOptionSetting struct {

	// Indicates the acceptable values for the option group option.
	AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB engine specific parameter type for the option group option.
	ApplyType *string `type:"string"`

	// The default value for the option group option.
	DefaultValue *string `type:"string"`

	// Boolean value where true indicates that this option group option can be changed
	// from the default value.
	IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The description of the option group option.
	SettingDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the option group option.
	SettingName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Option group option settings are used to display settings available for each option with their default values and other information. These values are used with the DescribeOptionGroupOptions action.

func (OptionGroupOptionSetting) GoString

func (s OptionGroupOptionSetting) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetAllowedValues

SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetApplyType

SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetDefaultValue

SetDefaultValue sets the DefaultValue field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetIsModifiable

SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetSettingDescription

func (s *OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetSettingDescription(v string) *OptionGroupOptionSetting

SetSettingDescription sets the SettingDescription field's value.

func (*OptionGroupOptionSetting) SetSettingName

SetSettingName sets the SettingName field's value.

func (OptionGroupOptionSetting) String

func (s OptionGroupOptionSetting) String() string

String returns the string representation

type OptionSetting

type OptionSetting struct {

	// The allowed values of the option setting.
	AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB engine specific parameter type.
	ApplyType *string `type:"string"`

	// The data type of the option setting.
	DataType *string `type:"string"`

	// The default value of the option setting.
	DefaultValue *string `type:"string"`

	// The description of the option setting.
	Description *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates if the option setting is part of a collection.
	IsCollection *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A Boolean value that, when true, indicates the option setting can be modified
	// from the default.
	IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the option that has settings that you can set.
	Name *string `type:"string"`

	// The current value of the option setting.
	Value *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Option settings are the actual settings being applied or configured for that option. It is used when you modify an option group or describe option groups. For example, the NATIVE_NETWORK_ENCRYPTION option has a setting called SQLNET.ENCRYPTION_SERVER that can have several different values.

func (OptionSetting) GoString

func (s OptionSetting) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*OptionSetting) SetAllowedValues

func (s *OptionSetting) SetAllowedValues(v string) *OptionSetting

SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.

func (*OptionSetting) SetApplyType

func (s *OptionSetting) SetApplyType(v string) *OptionSetting

SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.

func (*OptionSetting) SetDataType

func (s *OptionSetting) SetDataType(v string) *OptionSetting

SetDataType sets the DataType field's value.

func (*OptionSetting) SetDefaultValue

func (s *OptionSetting) SetDefaultValue(v string) *OptionSetting

SetDefaultValue sets the DefaultValue field's value.

func (*OptionSetting) SetDescription

func (s *OptionSetting) SetDescription(v string) *OptionSetting

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (*OptionSetting) SetIsCollection

func (s *OptionSetting) SetIsCollection(v bool) *OptionSetting

SetIsCollection sets the IsCollection field's value.

func (*OptionSetting) SetIsModifiable

func (s *OptionSetting) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *OptionSetting

SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.

func (*OptionSetting) SetName

func (s *OptionSetting) SetName(v string) *OptionSetting

SetName sets the Name field's value.

func (*OptionSetting) SetValue

func (s *OptionSetting) SetValue(v string) *OptionSetting

SetValue sets the Value field's value.

func (OptionSetting) String

func (s OptionSetting) String() string

String returns the string representation

type OptionVersion

type OptionVersion struct {

	// True if the version is the default version of the option, and otherwise false.
	IsDefault *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The version of the option.
	Version *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

The version for an option. Option group option versions are returned by the DescribeOptionGroupOptions action.

func (OptionVersion) GoString

func (s OptionVersion) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*OptionVersion) SetIsDefault

func (s *OptionVersion) SetIsDefault(v bool) *OptionVersion

SetIsDefault sets the IsDefault field's value.

func (*OptionVersion) SetVersion

func (s *OptionVersion) SetVersion(v string) *OptionVersion

SetVersion sets the Version field's value.

func (OptionVersion) String

func (s OptionVersion) String() string

String returns the string representation

type OrderableDBInstanceOption

type OrderableDBInstanceOption struct {

	// A list of Availability Zones for a DB instance.
	AvailabilityZones []*AvailabilityZone `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`

	// The DB instance class for a DB instance.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// The engine type of a DB instance.
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// The engine version of a DB instance.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The license model for a DB instance.
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// Maximum total provisioned IOPS for a DB instance.
	MaxIopsPerDbInstance *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Maximum provisioned IOPS per GiB for a DB instance.
	MaxIopsPerGib *float64 `type:"double"`

	// Maximum storage size for a DB instance.
	MaxStorageSize *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Minimum total provisioned IOPS for a DB instance.
	MinIopsPerDbInstance *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Minimum provisioned IOPS per GiB for a DB instance.
	MinIopsPerGib *float64 `type:"double"`

	// Minimum storage size for a DB instance.
	MinStorageSize *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Indicates whether a DB instance is Multi-AZ capable.
	MultiAZCapable *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates whether a DB instance can have a Read Replica.
	ReadReplicaCapable *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates the storage type for a DB instance.
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates whether a DB instance supports Enhanced Monitoring at intervals
	// from 1 to 60 seconds.
	SupportsEnhancedMonitoring *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates whether a DB instance supports IAM database authentication.
	SupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates whether a DB instance supports provisioned IOPS.
	SupportsIops *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// True if a DB instance supports Performance Insights, otherwise false.
	SupportsPerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates whether a DB instance supports encrypted storage.
	SupportsStorageEncryption *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Indicates whether a DB instance is in a VPC.
	Vpc *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains a list of available options for a DB instance.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions action.

func (OrderableDBInstanceOption) GoString

func (s OrderableDBInstanceOption) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetAvailabilityZones

SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetEngineVersion

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetLicenseModel

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxIopsPerDbInstance

func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxIopsPerDbInstance(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption

SetMaxIopsPerDbInstance sets the MaxIopsPerDbInstance field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxIopsPerGib

SetMaxIopsPerGib sets the MaxIopsPerGib field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMaxStorageSize

SetMaxStorageSize sets the MaxStorageSize field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinIopsPerDbInstance

func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinIopsPerDbInstance(v int64) *OrderableDBInstanceOption

SetMinIopsPerDbInstance sets the MinIopsPerDbInstance field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinIopsPerGib

SetMinIopsPerGib sets the MinIopsPerGib field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMinStorageSize

SetMinStorageSize sets the MinStorageSize field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMultiAZCapable

func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetMultiAZCapable(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption

SetMultiAZCapable sets the MultiAZCapable field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetReadReplicaCapable

func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetReadReplicaCapable(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption

SetReadReplicaCapable sets the ReadReplicaCapable field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetStorageType

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsEnhancedMonitoring

func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsEnhancedMonitoring(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption

SetSupportsEnhancedMonitoring sets the SupportsEnhancedMonitoring field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption

SetSupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the SupportsIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsIops

SetSupportsIops sets the SupportsIops field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsPerformanceInsights

func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsPerformanceInsights(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption

SetSupportsPerformanceInsights sets the SupportsPerformanceInsights field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsStorageEncryption

func (s *OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetSupportsStorageEncryption(v bool) *OrderableDBInstanceOption

SetSupportsStorageEncryption sets the SupportsStorageEncryption field's value.

func (*OrderableDBInstanceOption) SetVpc

SetVpc sets the Vpc field's value.

func (OrderableDBInstanceOption) String

func (s OrderableDBInstanceOption) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Parameter

type Parameter struct {

	// Specifies the valid range of values for the parameter.
	AllowedValues *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates when to apply parameter updates.
	ApplyMethod *string `type:"string" enum:"ApplyMethod"`

	// Specifies the engine specific parameters type.
	ApplyType *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the valid data type for the parameter.
	DataType *string `type:"string"`

	// Provides a description of the parameter.
	Description *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates whether (true) or not (false) the parameter can be modified. Some
	// parameters have security or operational implications that prevent them from
	// being changed.
	IsModifiable *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The earliest engine version to which the parameter can apply.
	MinimumEngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the name of the parameter.
	ParameterName *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the value of the parameter.
	ParameterValue *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates the source of the parameter value.
	Source *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a request parameter in the ModifyDBParameterGroup and ResetDBParameterGroup actions.

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters and DescribeDBParameters actions.

func (Parameter) GoString

func (s Parameter) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Parameter) SetAllowedValues

func (s *Parameter) SetAllowedValues(v string) *Parameter

SetAllowedValues sets the AllowedValues field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetApplyMethod

func (s *Parameter) SetApplyMethod(v string) *Parameter

SetApplyMethod sets the ApplyMethod field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetApplyType

func (s *Parameter) SetApplyType(v string) *Parameter

SetApplyType sets the ApplyType field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetDataType

func (s *Parameter) SetDataType(v string) *Parameter

SetDataType sets the DataType field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetDescription

func (s *Parameter) SetDescription(v string) *Parameter

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetIsModifiable

func (s *Parameter) SetIsModifiable(v bool) *Parameter

SetIsModifiable sets the IsModifiable field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetMinimumEngineVersion

func (s *Parameter) SetMinimumEngineVersion(v string) *Parameter

SetMinimumEngineVersion sets the MinimumEngineVersion field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetParameterName

func (s *Parameter) SetParameterName(v string) *Parameter

SetParameterName sets the ParameterName field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetParameterValue

func (s *Parameter) SetParameterValue(v string) *Parameter

SetParameterValue sets the ParameterValue field's value.

func (*Parameter) SetSource

func (s *Parameter) SetSource(v string) *Parameter

SetSource sets the Source field's value.

func (Parameter) String

func (s Parameter) String() string

String returns the string representation

type PendingCloudwatchLogsExports

type PendingCloudwatchLogsExports struct {

	// Log types that are in the process of being enabled. After they are enabled,
	// these log types are exported to CloudWatch Logs.
	LogTypesToDisable []*string `type:"list"`

	// Log types that are in the process of being deactivated. After they are deactivated,
	// these log types aren't exported to CloudWatch Logs.
	LogTypesToEnable []*string `type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

A list of the log types whose configuration is still pending. In other words, these log types are in the process of being activated or deactivated.

func (PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) GoString

func (s PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) SetLogTypesToDisable

func (s *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) SetLogTypesToDisable(v []*string) *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports

SetLogTypesToDisable sets the LogTypesToDisable field's value.

func (*PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) SetLogTypesToEnable

SetLogTypesToEnable sets the LogTypesToEnable field's value.

func (PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) String

String returns the string representation

type PendingMaintenanceAction

type PendingMaintenanceAction struct {

	// The type of pending maintenance action that is available for the resource.
	Action *string `type:"string"`

	// The date of the maintenance window when the action is applied. The maintenance
	// action is applied to the resource during its first maintenance window after
	// this date. If this date is specified, any next-maintenance opt-in requests
	// are ignored.
	AutoAppliedAfterDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// The effective date when the pending maintenance action is applied to the
	// resource. This date takes into account opt-in requests received from the
	// ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction API, the AutoAppliedAfterDate, and the ForcedApplyDate.
	// This value is blank if an opt-in request has not been received and nothing
	// has been specified as AutoAppliedAfterDate or ForcedApplyDate.
	CurrentApplyDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// A description providing more detail about the maintenance action.
	Description *string `type:"string"`

	// The date when the maintenance action is automatically applied. The maintenance
	// action is applied to the resource on this date regardless of the maintenance
	// window for the resource. If this date is specified, any immediate opt-in
	// requests are ignored.
	ForcedApplyDate *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// Indicates the type of opt-in request that has been received for the resource.
	OptInStatus *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Provides information about a pending maintenance action for a resource.

func (PendingMaintenanceAction) GoString

func (s PendingMaintenanceAction) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PendingMaintenanceAction) SetAction

SetAction sets the Action field's value.

func (*PendingMaintenanceAction) SetAutoAppliedAfterDate

func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetAutoAppliedAfterDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction

SetAutoAppliedAfterDate sets the AutoAppliedAfterDate field's value.

func (*PendingMaintenanceAction) SetCurrentApplyDate

func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetCurrentApplyDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction

SetCurrentApplyDate sets the CurrentApplyDate field's value.

func (*PendingMaintenanceAction) SetDescription

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (*PendingMaintenanceAction) SetForcedApplyDate

func (s *PendingMaintenanceAction) SetForcedApplyDate(v time.Time) *PendingMaintenanceAction

SetForcedApplyDate sets the ForcedApplyDate field's value.

func (*PendingMaintenanceAction) SetOptInStatus

SetOptInStatus sets the OptInStatus field's value.

func (PendingMaintenanceAction) String

func (s PendingMaintenanceAction) String() string

String returns the string representation

type PendingModifiedValues

type PendingModifiedValues struct {

	// Contains the new AllocatedStorage size for the DB instance that will be applied
	// or is currently being applied.
	AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the pending number of days for which automated backups are retained.
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the identifier of the CA certificate for the DB instance.
	CACertificateIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains the new DBInstanceClass for the DB instance that will be applied
	// or is currently being applied.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains the new DBInstanceIdentifier for the DB instance that will be applied
	// or is currently being applied.
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// The new DB subnet group for the DB instance.
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates the database engine version.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the new Provisioned IOPS value for the DB instance that will be
	// applied or is currently being applied.
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The license model for the DB instance.
	//
	// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// Contains the pending or currently-in-progress change of the master credentials
	// for the DB instance.
	MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// Indicates that the Single-AZ DB instance is to change to a Multi-AZ deployment.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A list of the log types whose configuration is still pending. In other words,
	// these log types are in the process of being activated or deactivated.
	PendingCloudwatchLogsExports *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports `type:"structure"`

	// Specifies the pending port for the DB instance.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the ModifyDBInstance action.

func (PendingModifiedValues) GoString

func (s PendingModifiedValues) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetAllocatedStorage

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetAllocatedStorage(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues

SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *PendingModifiedValues

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetCACertificateIdentifier

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetCACertificateIdentifier(v string) *PendingModifiedValues

SetCACertificateIdentifier sets the CACertificateIdentifier field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetDBInstanceClass

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *PendingModifiedValues

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *PendingModifiedValues

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetDBSubnetGroupName

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetDBSubnetGroupName(v string) *PendingModifiedValues

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetEngineVersion

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetEngineVersion(v string) *PendingModifiedValues

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetIops

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetLicenseModel

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetLicenseModel(v string) *PendingModifiedValues

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetMasterUserPassword

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *PendingModifiedValues

SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetPendingCloudwatchLogsExports

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetPendingCloudwatchLogsExports(v *PendingCloudwatchLogsExports) *PendingModifiedValues

SetPendingCloudwatchLogsExports sets the PendingCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*PendingModifiedValues) SetStorageType

func (s *PendingModifiedValues) SetStorageType(v string) *PendingModifiedValues

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (PendingModifiedValues) String

func (s PendingModifiedValues) String() string

String returns the string representation

type PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput

type PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput struct {

	// The identifier of the DB cluster Read Replica to promote. This parameter
	// is not case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster Read Replica.
	//
	// Example: my-cluster-replica1
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput

type PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
	DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) SetDBCluster

SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.

func (PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type PromoteReadReplicaInput

type PromoteReadReplicaInput struct {

	// The number of days to retain automated backups. Setting this parameter to
	// a positive number enables backups. Setting this parameter to 0 disables automated
	// backups.
	//
	// Default: 1
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be a value from 0 to 8
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The DB instance identifier. This value is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing Read Replica DB instance.
	//
	// Example: mydbinstance
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
	// backups are enabled, using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see  Adjusting
	// the Preferred Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
	//
	//    * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	//    * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
	//
	//    * Must be at least 30 minutes.
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (PromoteReadReplicaInput) GoString

func (s PromoteReadReplicaInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *PromoteReadReplicaInput

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *PromoteReadReplicaInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *PromoteReadReplicaInput

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (PromoteReadReplicaInput) String

func (s PromoteReadReplicaInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*PromoteReadReplicaInput) Validate

func (s *PromoteReadReplicaInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type PromoteReadReplicaOutput

type PromoteReadReplicaOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (PromoteReadReplicaOutput) GoString

func (s PromoteReadReplicaOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PromoteReadReplicaOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (PromoteReadReplicaOutput) String

func (s PromoteReadReplicaOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput

type PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput struct {

	// The number of instances to reserve.
	//
	// Default: 1
	DBInstanceCount *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Customer-specified identifier to track this reservation.
	//
	// Example: myreservationID
	ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`

	// The ID of the Reserved DB instance offering to purchase.
	//
	// Example: 438012d3-4052-4cc7-b2e3-8d3372e0e706
	//
	// ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId is a required field
	ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetDBInstanceCount

SetDBInstanceCount sets the DBInstanceCount field's value.

func (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetReservedDBInstanceId

SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.

func (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId

SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.

func (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput

type PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput struct {

	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances
	// and PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering actions.
	ReservedDBInstance *ReservedDBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) SetReservedDBInstance

SetReservedDBInstance sets the ReservedDBInstance field's value.

func (PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type RDS

type RDS struct {
	*client.Client
}

RDS provides the API operation methods for making requests to Amazon Relational Database Service. See this package's package overview docs for details on the service.

RDS methods are safe to use concurrently. It is not safe to modify mutate any of the struct's properties though.

func New

func New(p client.ConfigProvider, cfgs ...*aws.Config) *RDS

New creates a new instance of the RDS client with a session. If additional configuration is needed for the client instance use the optional aws.Config parameter to add your extra config.

Example:

// Create a RDS client from just a session.
svc := rds.New(mySession)

// Create a RDS client with additional configuration
svc := rds.New(mySession, aws.NewConfig().WithRegion("us-west-2"))

func (*RDS) AddRoleToDBCluster

func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBCluster(input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) (*AddRoleToDBClusterOutput, error)

AddRoleToDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Associates an Identity and Access Management (IAM) role from an Aurora DB cluster. For more information, see Authorizing Amazon Aurora to Access Other AWS Services On Your Behalf (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Authorizing.AWSServices.html).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation AddRoleToDBCluster for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterRoleAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterRoleAlreadyExists" The specified IAM role Amazon Resource Name (ARN) is already associated with the specified DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterRoleQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterRoleQuotaExceeded" You have exceeded the maximum number of IAM roles that can be associated with the specified DB cluster.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddRoleToDBCluster

func (*RDS) AddRoleToDBClusterRequest

func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddRoleToDBClusterOutput)

AddRoleToDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the AddRoleToDBCluster operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See AddRoleToDBCluster for more information on using the AddRoleToDBCluster API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the AddRoleToDBClusterRequest method.
req, resp := client.AddRoleToDBClusterRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddRoleToDBCluster

func (*RDS) AddRoleToDBClusterWithContext

func (c *RDS) AddRoleToDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddRoleToDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddRoleToDBClusterOutput, error)

AddRoleToDBClusterWithContext is the same as AddRoleToDBCluster with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See AddRoleToDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription

func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription(input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput, error)

AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Adds a source identifier to an existing RDS event notification subscription.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound" The subscription name does not exist.

  • ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound" The requested source could not be found.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription

Example (Shared00)

To add a source identifier to an event notification subscription

This example add a source identifier to an event notification subscription.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput{
		SourceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		SubscriptionName: aws.String("mymysqleventsubscription"),
	}

	result, err := svc.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest

func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput)

AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for more information on using the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest method.
req, resp := client.AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription

func (*RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionWithContext

func (c *RDS) AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionOutput, error)

AddSourceIdentifierToSubscriptionWithContext is the same as AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) AddTagsToResource

func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResource(input *AddTagsToResourceInput) (*AddTagsToResourceOutput, error)

AddTagsToResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Adds metadata tags to an Amazon RDS resource. These tags can also be used with cost allocation reporting to track cost associated with Amazon RDS resources, or used in a Condition statement in an IAM policy for Amazon RDS.

For an overview on tagging Amazon RDS resources, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation AddTagsToResource for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddTagsToResource

Example (Shared00)

To add tags to a resource

This example adds a tag to an option group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.AddTagsToResourceInput{
		ResourceName: aws.String("arn:aws:rds:us-east-1:992648334831:og:mymysqloptiongroup"),
		Tags: []*rds.Tag{
			{
				Key:   aws.String("Staging"),
				Value: aws.String("LocationDB"),
			},
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.AddTagsToResource(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) AddTagsToResourceRequest

func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResourceRequest(input *AddTagsToResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *AddTagsToResourceOutput)

AddTagsToResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the AddTagsToResource operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See AddTagsToResource for more information on using the AddTagsToResource API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the AddTagsToResourceRequest method.
req, resp := client.AddTagsToResourceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AddTagsToResource

func (*RDS) AddTagsToResourceWithContext

func (c *RDS) AddTagsToResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AddTagsToResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AddTagsToResourceOutput, error)

AddTagsToResourceWithContext is the same as AddTagsToResource with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See AddTagsToResource for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction

func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction(input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput, error)

ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Applies a pending maintenance action to a resource (for example, to a DB instance).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault" The specified resource ID was not found.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction

Example (Shared00)

To apply a pending maintenance action

This example immediately applies a pending system update to a DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput{
		ApplyAction:        aws.String("system-update"),
		OptInType:          aws.String("immediate"),
		ResourceIdentifier: aws.String("arn:aws:rds:us-east-1:992648334831:db:mymysqlinstance"),
	}

	result, err := svc.ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest

func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput) (req *request.Request, output *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput)

ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for more information on using the ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest method.
req, resp := client.ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction

func (*RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionWithContext

func (c *RDS) ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionOutput, error)

ApplyPendingMaintenanceActionWithContext is the same as ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ApplyPendingMaintenanceAction for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress

func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress(input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error)

AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Enables ingress to a DBSecurityGroup using one of two forms of authorization. First, EC2 or VPC security groups can be added to the DBSecurityGroup if the application using the database is running on EC2 or VPC instances. Second, IP ranges are available if the application accessing your database is running on the Internet. Required parameters for this API are one of CIDR range, EC2SecurityGroupId for VPC, or (EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId for non-VPC).

You can't authorize ingress from an EC2 security group in one AWS Region to an Amazon RDS DB instance in another. You can't authorize ingress from a VPC security group in one VPC to an Amazon RDS DB instance in another.

For an overview of CIDR ranges, go to the Wikipedia Tutorial (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Classless_Inter-Domain_Routing).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState" The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault "AuthorizationAlreadyExists" The specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is already authorized for the specified DB security group.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault "AuthorizationQuotaExceeded" DB security group authorization quota has been reached.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress

Example (Shared00)

To authorize DB security group integress

This example authorizes access to the specified security group by the specified CIDR block.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput{
		CIDRIP:              aws.String("203.0.113.5/32"),
		DBSecurityGroupName: aws.String("mydbsecuritygroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest

func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (req *request.Request, output *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput)

AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for more information on using the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest method.
req, resp := client.AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress

func (*RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext

func (c *RDS) AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput, opts ...request.Option) (*AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error)

AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext is the same as AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See AuthorizeDBSecurityGroupIngress for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroup(input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error)

CopyDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Copies the specified DB cluster parameter group.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter groups.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists" A DB parameter group with the same name exists.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To copy a DB cluster parameter group

This example copies a DB cluster parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput{
		SourceDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier:  aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup"),
		TargetDBClusterParameterGroupDescription: aws.String("My DB cluster parameter group copy"),
		TargetDBClusterParameterGroupIdentifier:  aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup-copy"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CopyDBClusterParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput)

CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CopyDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the CopyDBClusterParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.CopyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterParameterGroup

func (*RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error)

CopyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CopyDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CopyDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshot

func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshot(input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error)

CopyDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Copies a snapshot of a DB cluster.

To copy a DB cluster snapshot from a shared manual DB cluster snapshot, SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier must be the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the shared DB cluster snapshot.

You can copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region. In that case, the AWS Region where you call the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action is the destination AWS Region for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied to. To copy an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from another AWS Region, you must provide the following values:

  • KmsKeyId - The AWS Key Management System (AWS KMS) key identifier for the key to use to encrypt the copy of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region.

  • PreSignedUrl - A URL that contains a Signature Version 4 signed request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action to be called in the source AWS Region where the DB cluster snapshot is copied from. The pre-signed URL must be a valid request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot API action that can be executed in the source AWS Region that contains the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied.

The pre-signed URL request must contain the following parameter values:

KmsKeyId - The KMS key identifier for the key to use to encrypt the copy

of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region. This is the
same identifier for both the CopyDBClusterSnapshot action that is called
in the destination AWS Region, and the action contained in the pre-signed
URL.

DestinationRegion - The name of the AWS Region that the DB cluster snapshot

will be created in.

SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier for

the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must be
in the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) format for the source AWS Region. For
example, if you are copying an encrypted DB cluster snapshot from the
us-west-2 AWS Region, then your SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier looks
like the following example: arn:aws:rds:us-west-2:123456789012:cluster-snapshot:aurora-cluster1-snapshot-20161115.

To learn how to generate a Signature Version 4 signed request, see Authenticating

Requests: Using Query Parameters (AWS Signature Version 4) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/API/sigv4-query-string-auth.html)
and  Signature Version 4 Signing Process (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/general/latest/gr/signature-version-4.html).

* TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The identifier for the new copy
of the DB cluster snapshot in the destination AWS Region.

* SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier - The DB cluster snapshot identifier
for the encrypted DB cluster snapshot to be copied. This identifier must
be in the ARN format for the source AWS Region and is the same value as
the SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier in the pre-signed URL.

To cancel the copy operation once it is in progress, delete the target DB cluster snapshot identified by TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier while that DB cluster snapshot is in "copying" status.

For more information on copying encrypted DB cluster snapshots from one AWS Region to another, see Copying a DB Cluster Snapshot in the Same Account, Either in the Same Region or Across Regions (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopySnapshot.html#USER_CopyDBClusterSnapshot.CrossRegion) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CopyDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault" User already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault" DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault" The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.

  • ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterSnapshot

Example (Shared00)

To copy a DB cluster snapshot

The following example copies an automated snapshot of a DB cluster to a new DB cluster snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput{
		SourceDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("rds:sample-cluster-2016-09-14-10-38"),
		TargetDBClusterSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("cluster-snapshot-copy-1"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CopyDBClusterSnapshot(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput)

CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CopyDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CopyDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the CopyDBClusterSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.CopyDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBClusterSnapshot

func (*RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) CopyDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error)

CopyDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as CopyDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CopyDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CopyDBParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroup(input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) (*CopyDBParameterGroupOutput, error)

CopyDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Copies the specified DB parameter group.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CopyDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists" A DB parameter group with the same name exists.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter groups.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To copy a DB parameter group

This example copies a DB parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CopyDBParameterGroupInput{
		SourceDBParameterGroupIdentifier:  aws.String("mymysqlparametergroup"),
		TargetDBParameterGroupDescription: aws.String("My MySQL parameter group copy"),
		TargetDBParameterGroupIdentifier:  aws.String("mymysqlparametergroup-copy"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CopyDBParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CopyDBParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBParameterGroupOutput)

CopyDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CopyDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CopyDBParameterGroup for more information on using the CopyDBParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CopyDBParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.CopyDBParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBParameterGroup

func (*RDS) CopyDBParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) CopyDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBParameterGroupOutput, error)

CopyDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CopyDBParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CopyDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CopyDBSnapshot

func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshot(input *CopyDBSnapshotInput) (*CopyDBSnapshotOutput, error)

CopyDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Copies the specified DB snapshot. The source DB snapshot must be in the "available" state.

You can copy a snapshot from one AWS Region to another. In that case, the AWS Region where you call the CopyDBSnapshot action is the destination AWS Region for the DB snapshot copy.

For more information about copying snapshots, see Copying a DB Snapshot (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_CopyDBSnapshot.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CopyDBSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists" DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState" The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBSnapshot

Example (Shared00)

To copy a DB snapshot

This example copies a DB snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CopyDBSnapshotInput{
		SourceDBSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbsnapshot"),
		TargetDBSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbsnapshot-copy"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CopyDBSnapshot(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CopyDBSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshotRequest(input *CopyDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyDBSnapshotOutput)

CopyDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CopyDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CopyDBSnapshot for more information on using the CopyDBSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CopyDBSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.CopyDBSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyDBSnapshot

func (*RDS) CopyDBSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) CopyDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyDBSnapshotOutput, error)

CopyDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as CopyDBSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CopyDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CopyOptionGroup

func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroup(input *CopyOptionGroupInput) (*CopyOptionGroupOutput, error)

CopyOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Copies the specified option group.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CopyOptionGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault "OptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault" The option group you are trying to create already exists.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault "OptionGroupQuotaExceededFault" The quota of 20 option groups was exceeded for this AWS account.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyOptionGroup

Example (Shared00)

To copy an option group

This example copies an option group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CopyOptionGroupInput{
		SourceOptionGroupIdentifier:  aws.String("mymysqloptiongroup"),
		TargetOptionGroupDescription: aws.String("My MySQL option group copy"),
		TargetOptionGroupIdentifier:  aws.String("mymysqloptiongroup-copy"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CopyOptionGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CopyOptionGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroupRequest(input *CopyOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CopyOptionGroupOutput)

CopyOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CopyOptionGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CopyOptionGroup for more information on using the CopyOptionGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CopyOptionGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.CopyOptionGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CopyOptionGroup

func (*RDS) CopyOptionGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) CopyOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CopyOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CopyOptionGroupOutput, error)

CopyOptionGroupWithContext is the same as CopyOptionGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CopyOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBCluster

func (c *RDS) CreateDBCluster(input *CreateDBClusterInput) (*CreateDBClusterOutput, error)

CreateDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new Amazon Aurora DB cluster.

You can use the ReplicationSourceIdentifier parameter to create the DB cluster as a Read Replica of another DB cluster or Amazon RDS MySQL DB instance. For cross-region replication where the DB cluster identified by ReplicationSourceIdentifier is encrypted, you must also specify the PreSignedUrl parameter.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBCluster for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault" User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity" There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different Availability Zones that have more storage available.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault" User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault" The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound" DBClusterParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB Cluster parameter group.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBCluster

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB cluster

This example creates a DB cluster.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBClusterInput{
		AvailabilityZones: []*string{
			aws.String("us-east-1a"),
		},
		BackupRetentionPeriod:       aws.Int64(1),
		DBClusterIdentifier:         aws.String("mydbcluster"),
		DBClusterParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup"),
		DatabaseName:                aws.String("myauroradb"),
		Engine:                      aws.String("aurora"),
		EngineVersion:               aws.String("5.6.10a"),
		MasterUserPassword:          aws.String("mypassword"),
		MasterUsername:              aws.String("myuser"),
		Port:                        aws.Int64(3306),
		StorageEncrypted:            aws.Bool(true),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBCluster(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroup(input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error)

CreateDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new DB cluster parameter group.

Parameters in a DB cluster parameter group apply to all of the instances in a DB cluster.

A DB cluster parameter group is initially created with the default parameters for the database engine used by instances in the DB cluster. To provide custom values for any of the parameters, you must modify the group after creating it using ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup. Once you've created a DB cluster parameter group, you need to associate it with your DB cluster using ModifyDBCluster. When you associate a new DB cluster parameter group with a running DB cluster, you need to reboot the DB instances in the DB cluster without failover for the new DB cluster parameter group and associated settings to take effect.

After you create a DB cluster parameter group, you should wait at least 5 minutes before creating your first DB cluster that uses that DB cluster parameter group as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete the create action before the DB cluster parameter group is used as the default for a new DB cluster. This is especially important for parameters that are critical when creating the default database for a DB cluster, such as the character set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter. You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/) or the DescribeDBClusterParameters command to verify that your DB cluster parameter group has been created or modified.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter groups.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists" A DB parameter group with the same name exists.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB cluster parameter group

This example creates a DB cluster parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput{
		DBClusterParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup"),
		DBParameterGroupFamily:      aws.String("aurora5.6"),
		Description:                 aws.String("My DB cluster parameter group"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBClusterParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput)

CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the CreateDBClusterParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterParameterGroup

func (*RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error)

CreateDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBClusterRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterRequest(input *CreateDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterOutput)

CreateDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBCluster operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBCluster for more information on using the CreateDBCluster API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBCluster

func (*RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshot

func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshot(input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error)

CreateDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a snapshot of a DB cluster. For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault" User already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault" The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterSnapshot

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB cluster snapshot

This example creates a DB cluster snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput{
		DBClusterIdentifier:         aws.String("mydbcluster"),
		DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbclustersnapshot"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBClusterSnapshot(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput)

CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the CreateDBClusterSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBClusterSnapshot

func (*RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error)

CreateDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as CreateDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBClusterWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBClusterOutput, error)

CreateDBClusterWithContext is the same as CreateDBCluster with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBInstance

func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstance(input *CreateDBInstanceInput) (*CreateDBInstanceOutput, error)

CreateDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new DB instance.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBInstance for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists" User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity" Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

  • ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault" Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported" StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified DB security group.

    RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your behalf.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

  • ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault" Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstance

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB instance.

This example creates a DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBInstanceInput{
		AllocatedStorage:     aws.Int64(5),
		DBInstanceClass:      aws.String("db.t2.micro"),
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		Engine:               aws.String("MySQL"),
		MasterUserPassword:   aws.String("MyPassword"),
		MasterUsername:       aws.String("MyUser"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBInstance(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplica

func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplica(input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput, error)

CreateDBInstanceReadReplica API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new DB instance that acts as a Read Replica for an existing source DB instance. You can create a Read Replica for a DB instance running MySQL, MariaDB, or PostgreSQL. For more information, see Working with PostgreSQL, MySQL, and MariaDB Read Replicas (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_ReadRepl.html).

Amazon Aurora doesn't support this action. You must call the CreateDBInstance action to create a DB instance for an Aurora DB cluster.

All Read Replica DB instances are created with backups disabled. All other DB instance attributes (including DB security groups and DB parameter groups) are inherited from the source DB instance, except as specified following.

Your source DB instance must have backup retention enabled.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists" User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity" Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

  • ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault" Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault "DBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault" Indicates that the DBSubnetGroup should not be specified while creating read replicas that lie in the same region as the source instance.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupFault" Indicates the DBSubnetGroup does not belong to the same VPC as that of an existing cross region read replica of the same source instance.

  • ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported" StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstanceReadReplica

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB instance read replica.

This example creates a DB instance read replica.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput{
		AvailabilityZone:           aws.String("us-east-1a"),
		CopyTagsToSnapshot:         aws.Bool(true),
		DBInstanceClass:            aws.String("db.t2.micro"),
		DBInstanceIdentifier:       aws.String("mydbreadreplica"),
		PubliclyAccessible:         aws.Bool(true),
		SourceDBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		StorageType:                aws.String("gp2"),
		Tags: []*rds.Tag{
			{
				Key:   aws.String("mydbreadreplicakey"),
				Value: aws.String("mydbreadreplicavalue"),
			},
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBInstanceReadReplica(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotAllowedFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput)

CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for more information on using the CreateDBInstanceReadReplica API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstanceReadReplica

func (*RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaOutput, error)

CreateDBInstanceReadReplicaWithContext is the same as CreateDBInstanceReadReplica with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBInstanceReadReplica for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBInstanceRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceRequest(input *CreateDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBInstanceOutput)

CreateDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBInstance operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBInstance for more information on using the CreateDBInstance API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBInstanceRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBInstanceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBInstance

func (*RDS) CreateDBInstanceWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBInstanceOutput, error)

CreateDBInstanceWithContext is the same as CreateDBInstance with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroup(input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) (*CreateDBParameterGroupOutput, error)

CreateDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new DB parameter group.

A DB parameter group is initially created with the default parameters for the database engine used by the DB instance. To provide custom values for any of the parameters, you must modify the group after creating it using ModifyDBParameterGroup. Once you've created a DB parameter group, you need to associate it with your DB instance using ModifyDBInstance. When you associate a new DB parameter group with a running DB instance, you need to reboot the DB instance without failover for the new DB parameter group and associated settings to take effect.

After you create a DB parameter group, you should wait at least 5 minutes before creating your first DB instance that uses that DB parameter group as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete the create action before the parameter group is used as the default for a new DB instance. This is especially important for parameters that are critical when creating the default database for a DB instance, such as the character set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter. You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/) or the DescribeDBParameters command to verify that your DB parameter group has been created or modified.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBParameterGroupQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB parameter groups.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBParameterGroupAlreadyExists" A DB parameter group with the same name exists.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB parameter group.

This example creates a DB parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBParameterGroupInput{
		DBParameterGroupFamily: aws.String("mysql5.6"),
		DBParameterGroupName:   aws.String("mymysqlparametergroup"),
		Description:            aws.String("My MySQL parameter group"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBParameterGroupOutput)

CreateDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBParameterGroup for more information on using the CreateDBParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBParameterGroup

func (*RDS) CreateDBParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBParameterGroupOutput, error)

CreateDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroup

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroup(input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) (*CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput, error)

CreateDBSecurityGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new DB security group. DB security groups control access to a DB instance.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBSecurityGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBSecurityGroupAlreadyExists" A DB security group with the name specified in DBSecurityGroupName already exists.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupQuotaExceededFault "QuotaExceeded.DBSecurityGroup" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB security groups.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotSupportedFault "DBSecurityGroupNotSupported" A DB security group is not allowed for this action.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSecurityGroup

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB security group.

This example creates a DB security group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBSecurityGroupInput{
		DBSecurityGroupDescription: aws.String("My DB security group"),
		DBSecurityGroupName:        aws.String("mydbsecuritygroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBSecurityGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotSupportedFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotSupportedFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput)

CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBSecurityGroup for more information on using the CreateDBSecurityGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBSecurityGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSecurityGroup

func (*RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSecurityGroupOutput, error)

CreateDBSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBSecurityGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBSnapshot

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshot(input *CreateDBSnapshotInput) (*CreateDBSnapshotOutput, error)

CreateDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a DBSnapshot. The source DBInstance must be in "available" state.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists" DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSnapshot

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB snapshot.

This example creates a DB snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBSnapshotInput{
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		DBSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbsnapshot"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBSnapshot(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshotRequest(input *CreateDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSnapshotOutput)

CreateDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBSnapshot for more information on using the CreateDBSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSnapshot

func (*RDS) CreateDBSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSnapshotOutput, error)

CreateDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as CreateDBSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroup

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroup(input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) (*CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput, error)

CreateDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new DB subnet group. DB subnet groups must contain at least one subnet in at least two AZs in the AWS Region.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupAlreadyExistsFault "DBSubnetGroupAlreadyExists" DBSubnetGroupName is already used by an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetGroupQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB subnet groups.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetQuotaExceededFault" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of subnets in a DB subnet groups.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSubnetGroup

Example (Shared00)

To create a DB subnet group.

This example creates a DB subnet group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateDBSubnetGroupInput{
		DBSubnetGroupDescription: aws.String("My DB subnet group"),
		DBSubnetGroupName:        aws.String("mydbsubnetgroup"),
		SubnetIds: []*string{
			aws.String("subnet-1fab8a69"),
			aws.String("subnet-d43a468c"),
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateDBSubnetGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput)

CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the CreateDBSubnetGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateDBSubnetGroup

func (*RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateDBSubnetGroupOutput, error)

CreateDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as CreateDBSubnetGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateEventSubscription

func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscription(input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput, error)

CreateEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates an RDS event notification subscription. This action requires a topic ARN (Amazon Resource Name) created by either the RDS console, the SNS console, or the SNS API. To obtain an ARN with SNS, you must create a topic in Amazon SNS and subscribe to the topic. The ARN is displayed in the SNS console.

You can specify the type of source (SourceType) you want to be notified of, provide a list of RDS sources (SourceIds) that triggers the events, and provide a list of event categories (EventCategories) for events you want to be notified of. For example, you can specify SourceType = db-instance, SourceIds = mydbinstance1, mydbinstance2 and EventCategories = Availability, Backup.

If you specify both the SourceType and SourceIds, such as SourceType = db-instance and SourceIdentifier = myDBInstance1, you are notified of all the db-instance events for the specified source. If you specify a SourceType but do not specify a SourceIdentifier, you receive notice of the events for that source type for all your RDS sources. If you do not specify either the SourceType nor the SourceIdentifier, you are notified of events generated from all RDS sources belonging to your customer account.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateEventSubscription for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded" You have reached the maximum number of event subscriptions.

  • ErrCodeSubscriptionAlreadyExistFault "SubscriptionAlreadyExist" The supplied subscription name already exists.

  • ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault "SNSInvalidTopic" SNS has responded that there is a problem with the SND topic specified.

  • ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault "SNSNoAuthorization" You do not have permission to publish to the SNS topic ARN.

  • ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault "SNSTopicArnNotFound" The SNS topic ARN does not exist.

  • ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound" The supplied category does not exist.

  • ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound" The requested source could not be found.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateEventSubscription

Example (Shared00)

To create an event notification subscription

This example creates an event notification subscription.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateEventSubscriptionInput{
		Enabled: aws.Bool(true),
		EventCategories: []*string{
			aws.String("availability"),
		},
		SnsTopicArn: aws.String("arn:aws:sns:us-east-1:992648334831:MyDemoSNSTopic"),
		SourceIds: []*string{
			aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		},
		SourceType:       aws.String("db-instance"),
		SubscriptionName: aws.String("mymysqleventsubscription"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateEventSubscription(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionAlreadyExistFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionAlreadyExistFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateEventSubscriptionRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateEventSubscriptionOutput)

CreateEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateEventSubscription operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateEventSubscription for more information on using the CreateEventSubscription API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateEventSubscriptionRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateEventSubscriptionRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateEventSubscription

func (*RDS) CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateEventSubscriptionOutput, error)

CreateEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as CreateEventSubscription with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) CreateOptionGroup

func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroup(input *CreateOptionGroupInput) (*CreateOptionGroupOutput, error)

CreateOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new option group. You can create up to 20 option groups.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation CreateOptionGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault "OptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault" The option group you are trying to create already exists.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault "OptionGroupQuotaExceededFault" The quota of 20 option groups was exceeded for this AWS account.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateOptionGroup

Example (Shared00)

To create an option group

This example creates an option group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.CreateOptionGroupInput{
		EngineName:             aws.String("MySQL"),
		MajorEngineVersion:     aws.String("5.6"),
		OptionGroupDescription: aws.String("My MySQL 5.6 option group"),
		OptionGroupName:        aws.String("mymysqloptiongroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.CreateOptionGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) CreateOptionGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroupRequest(input *CreateOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateOptionGroupOutput)

CreateOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the CreateOptionGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See CreateOptionGroup for more information on using the CreateOptionGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the CreateOptionGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.CreateOptionGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/CreateOptionGroup

func (*RDS) CreateOptionGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) CreateOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateOptionGroupOutput, error)

CreateOptionGroupWithContext is the same as CreateOptionGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See CreateOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteDBCluster

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBCluster(input *DeleteDBClusterInput) (*DeleteDBClusterOutput, error)

DeleteDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

The DeleteDBCluster action deletes a previously provisioned DB cluster. When you delete a DB cluster, all automated backups for that DB cluster are deleted and can't be recovered. Manual DB cluster snapshots of the specified DB cluster are not deleted.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html)in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteDBCluster for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault" User already has a DB cluster snapshot with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault" The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBCluster

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB cluster.

This example deletes the specified DB cluster.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteDBClusterInput{
		DBClusterIdentifier: aws.String("mydbcluster"),
		SkipFinalSnapshot:   aws.Bool(true),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteDBCluster(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup(input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error)

DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Deletes a specified DB cluster parameter group. The DB cluster parameter group to be deleted can't be associated with any DB clusters.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState" The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group is in this state.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB cluster parameter group.

This example deletes the specified DB cluster parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput{
		DBClusterParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput)

DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup

func (*RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupOutput, error)

DeleteDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteDBClusterRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterOutput)

DeleteDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteDBCluster operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteDBCluster for more information on using the DeleteDBCluster API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBCluster

func (*RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshot

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshot(input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error)

DeleteDBClusterSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Deletes a DB cluster snapshot. If the snapshot is being copied, the copy operation is terminated.

The DB cluster snapshot must be in the available state to be deleted.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault" The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault" DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterSnapshot

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB cluster snapshot.

This example deletes the specified DB cluster snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput{
		DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbclustersnapshot"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteDBClusterSnapshot(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput)

DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteDBClusterSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for more information on using the DeleteDBClusterSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteDBClusterSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBClusterSnapshot

func (*RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterSnapshotOutput, error)

DeleteDBClusterSnapshotWithContext is the same as DeleteDBClusterSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteDBClusterSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteDBClusterWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBClusterOutput, error)

DeleteDBClusterWithContext is the same as DeleteDBCluster with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteDBInstance

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstance(input *DeleteDBInstanceInput) (*DeleteDBInstanceOutput, error)

DeleteDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

The DeleteDBInstance action deletes a previously provisioned DB instance. When you delete a DB instance, all automated backups for that instance are deleted and can't be recovered. Manual DB snapshots of the DB instance to be deleted by DeleteDBInstance are not deleted.

If you request a final DB snapshot the status of the Amazon RDS DB instance is deleting until the DB snapshot is created. The API action DescribeDBInstance is used to monitor the status of this operation. The action can't be canceled or reverted once submitted.

Note that when a DB instance is in a failure state and has a status of failed, incompatible-restore, or incompatible-network, you can only delete it when the SkipFinalSnapshot parameter is set to true.

If the specified DB instance is part of an Amazon Aurora DB cluster, you can't delete the DB instance if both of the following conditions are true:

  • The DB cluster is a Read Replica of another Amazon Aurora DB cluster.

  • The DB instance is the only instance in the DB cluster.

To delete a DB instance in this case, first call the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster API action to promote the DB cluster so it's no longer a Read Replica. After the promotion completes, then call the DeleteDBInstance API action to delete the final instance in the DB cluster.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteDBInstance for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists" DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.

  • ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBInstance

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB instance.

This example deletes the specified DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteDBInstanceInput{
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		SkipFinalSnapshot:    aws.Bool(true),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteDBInstance(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteDBInstanceRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceRequest(input *DeleteDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBInstanceOutput)

DeleteDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteDBInstance operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteDBInstance for more information on using the DeleteDBInstance API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteDBInstanceRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteDBInstanceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBInstance

func (*RDS) DeleteDBInstanceWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBInstanceOutput, error)

DeleteDBInstanceWithContext is the same as DeleteDBInstance with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroup(input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) (*DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput, error)

DeleteDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Deletes a specified DBParameterGroup. The DBParameterGroup to be deleted can't be associated with any DB instances.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState" The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group is in this state.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB parameter group

The following example deletes a DB parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteDBParameterGroupInput{
		DBParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbparamgroup3"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteDBParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput)

DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteDBParameterGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteDBParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBParameterGroup

func (*RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBParameterGroupOutput, error)

DeleteDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroup

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroup(input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) (*DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput, error)

DeleteDBSecurityGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Deletes a DB security group.

The specified DB security group must not be associated with any DB instances.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteDBSecurityGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState" The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSecurityGroup

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB security group

The following example deletes a DB security group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput{
		DBSecurityGroupName: aws.String("mysecgroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteDBSecurityGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput)

DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteDBSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteDBSecurityGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBSecurityGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteDBSecurityGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSecurityGroup

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSecurityGroupOutput, error)

DeleteDBSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSecurityGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteDBSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSnapshot

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshot(input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) (*DeleteDBSnapshotOutput, error)

DeleteDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Deletes a DBSnapshot. If the snapshot is being copied, the copy operation is terminated.

The DBSnapshot must be in the available state to be deleted.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteDBSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState" The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSnapshot

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB cluster snapshot.

This example deletes the specified DB snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteDBSnapshotInput{
		DBSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbsnapshot"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteDBSnapshot(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSnapshotOutput)

DeleteDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteDBSnapshot for more information on using the DeleteDBSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteDBSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSnapshot

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSnapshotOutput, error)

DeleteDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroup

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroup(input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) (*DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput, error)

DeleteDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Deletes a DB subnet group.

The specified database subnet group must not be associated with any DB instances.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault" The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetStateFault" The DB subnet is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSubnetGroup

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB subnet group.

This example deletes the specified DB subnetgroup.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput{
		DBSubnetGroupName: aws.String("mydbsubnetgroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteDBSubnetGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput)

DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the DeleteDBSubnetGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteDBSubnetGroup

func (*RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteDBSubnetGroupOutput, error)

DeleteDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteDBSubnetGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteEventSubscription

func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscription(input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput, error)

DeleteEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Deletes an RDS event notification subscription.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteEventSubscription for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound" The subscription name does not exist.

  • ErrCodeInvalidEventSubscriptionStateFault "InvalidEventSubscriptionState" This error can occur if someone else is modifying a subscription. You should retry the action.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteEventSubscription

Example (Shared00)

To delete a DB event subscription.

This example deletes the specified DB event subscription.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteEventSubscriptionInput{
		SubscriptionName: aws.String("myeventsubscription"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteEventSubscription(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidEventSubscriptionStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidEventSubscriptionStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput)

DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteEventSubscription operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteEventSubscription for more information on using the DeleteEventSubscription API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteEventSubscriptionRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteEventSubscription

func (*RDS) DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteEventSubscriptionOutput, error)

DeleteEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as DeleteEventSubscription with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DeleteOptionGroup

func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroup(input *DeleteOptionGroupInput) (*DeleteOptionGroupOutput, error)

DeleteOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Deletes an existing option group.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DeleteOptionGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault "InvalidOptionGroupStateFault" The option group is not in the available state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteOptionGroup

Example (Shared00)

To delete an option group.

This example deletes the specified option group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DeleteOptionGroupInput{
		OptionGroupName: aws.String("mydboptiongroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DeleteOptionGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DeleteOptionGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroupRequest(input *DeleteOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteOptionGroupOutput)

DeleteOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DeleteOptionGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DeleteOptionGroup for more information on using the DeleteOptionGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DeleteOptionGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.DeleteOptionGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DeleteOptionGroup

func (*RDS) DeleteOptionGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) DeleteOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteOptionGroupOutput, error)

DeleteOptionGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteOptionGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DeleteOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeAccountAttributes

func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributes(input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput, error)

DescribeAccountAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Lists all of the attributes for a customer account. The attributes include Amazon RDS quotas for the account, such as the number of DB instances allowed. The description for a quota includes the quota name, current usage toward that quota, and the quota's maximum value.

This command doesn't take any parameters.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeAccountAttributes for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeAccountAttributes

Example (Shared00)

To list account attributes

This example lists account attributes.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeAccountAttributesInput{}

	result, err := svc.DescribeAccountAttributes(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeAccountAttributesRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeAccountAttributesOutput)

DescribeAccountAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeAccountAttributes operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeAccountAttributes for more information on using the DescribeAccountAttributes API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeAccountAttributesRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeAccountAttributesRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeAccountAttributes

func (*RDS) DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeAccountAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeAccountAttributesOutput, error)

DescribeAccountAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeAccountAttributes with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeAccountAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeCertificates

func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificates(input *DescribeCertificatesInput) (*DescribeCertificatesOutput, error)

DescribeCertificates API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Lists the set of CA certificates provided by Amazon RDS for this AWS account.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeCertificates for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault "CertificateNotFound" CertificateIdentifier does not refer to an existing certificate.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeCertificates

Example (Shared00)

To list certificates

This example lists up to 20 certificates for the specified certificate identifier.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeCertificatesInput{
		CertificateIdentifier: aws.String("rds-ca-2015"),
		MaxRecords:            aws.Int64(20),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeCertificates(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeCertificatesRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificatesRequest(input *DescribeCertificatesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeCertificatesOutput)

DescribeCertificatesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeCertificates operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeCertificates for more information on using the DescribeCertificates API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeCertificatesRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeCertificatesRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeCertificates

func (*RDS) DescribeCertificatesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeCertificatesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeCertificatesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeCertificatesOutput, error)

DescribeCertificatesWithContext is the same as DescribeCertificates with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeCertificates for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups(input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of DBClusterParameterGroup descriptions. If a DBClusterParameterGroupName parameter is specified, the list will contain only the description of the specified DB cluster parameter group.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups

Example (Shared00)

To list DB cluster parameter group settings

This example lists settings for the specified DB cluster parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput{
		DBClusterParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput)

DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusterParameterGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBClusterParameterGroups for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameters

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParameters(input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) (*DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusterParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns the detailed parameter list for a particular DB cluster parameter group.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBClusterParameters for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameters

Example (Shared00)

To list DB cluster parameters

This example lists system parameters for the specified DB cluster parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBClusterParametersInput{
		DBClusterParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup"),
		Source:                      aws.String("system"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBClusterParameters(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput)

DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBClusterParameters operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBClusterParameters for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterParameters API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterParametersRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterParameters

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterParametersWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterParametersOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusterParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterParameters with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBClusterParameters for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of DB cluster snapshot attribute names and values for a manual DB cluster snapshot.

When sharing snapshots with other AWS accounts, DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes returns the restore attribute and a list of IDs for the AWS accounts that are authorized to copy or restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. If all is included in the list of values for the restore attribute, then the manual DB cluster snapshot is public and can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts.

To add or remove access for an AWS account to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot, or to make the manual DB cluster snapshot public or private, use the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API action.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault" DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes

Example (Shared00)

To list DB cluster snapshot attributes

This example lists attributes for the specified DB cluster snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput{
		DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbclustersnapshot"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput)

DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshots

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshots(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusterSnapshots API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns information about DB cluster snapshots. This API action supports pagination.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault" DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshots

Example (Shared00)

To list DB cluster snapshots

This example lists settings for the specified, manually-created cluster snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput{
		DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbclustersnapshot"),
		SnapshotType:                aws.String("manual"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBClusterSnapshots(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput)

DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for more information on using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshots API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusterSnapshots

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusterSnapshotsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusterSnapshots with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBClusterSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClusters

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClusters(input *DescribeDBClustersInput) (*DescribeDBClustersOutput, error)

DescribeDBClusters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns information about provisioned Aurora DB clusters. This API supports pagination.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBClusters for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusters

Example (Shared00)

To list DB clusters

This example lists settings for the specified DB cluster.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBClustersInput{
		DBClusterIdentifier: aws.String("mynewdbcluster"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBClusters(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClustersRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClustersRequest(input *DescribeDBClustersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBClustersOutput)

DescribeDBClustersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBClusters operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBClusters for more information on using the DescribeDBClusters API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBClustersRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBClustersRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBClusters

func (*RDS) DescribeDBClustersWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBClustersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBClustersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBClustersOutput, error)

DescribeDBClustersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBClusters with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBClusters for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersions

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersions(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, error)

DescribeDBEngineVersions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of the available DB engines.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBEngineVersions for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBEngineVersions

Example (Shared00)

To list DB engine version settings

This example lists settings for the specified DB engine version.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput{
		DBParameterGroupFamily:     aws.String("mysql5.6"),
		DefaultOnly:                aws.Bool(true),
		Engine:                     aws.String("mysql"),
		EngineVersion:              aws.String("5.6"),
		ListSupportedCharacterSets: aws.Bool(true),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBEngineVersions(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBEngineVersions operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeDBEngineVersions method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBEngineVersions operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeDBEngineVersionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBEngineVersionsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput)

DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBEngineVersions operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBEngineVersions for more information on using the DescribeDBEngineVersions API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBEngineVersionsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBEngineVersions

func (*RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBEngineVersionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBEngineVersionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBEngineVersionsOutput, error)

DescribeDBEngineVersionsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBEngineVersions with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBEngineVersions for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBInstances

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstances(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput) (*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, error)

DescribeDBInstances API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns information about provisioned RDS instances. This API supports pagination.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBInstances for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBInstances

Example (Shared00)

To list DB instance settings

This example lists settings for the specified DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBInstancesInput{
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBInstances(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBInstancesPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesPages(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeDBInstancesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBInstances operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeDBInstances method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBInstances operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeDBInstancesPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeDBInstancesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeDBInstancesPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBInstancesPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBInstancesRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesRequest(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBInstancesOutput)

DescribeDBInstancesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBInstances operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBInstances for more information on using the DescribeDBInstances API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBInstancesRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBInstancesRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBInstances

func (*RDS) DescribeDBInstancesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBInstancesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBInstancesOutput, error)

DescribeDBInstancesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBInstances with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBInstances for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBLogFiles

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFiles(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) (*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, error)

DescribeDBLogFiles API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of DB log files for the DB instance.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBLogFiles for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBLogFiles

Example (Shared00)

To list DB log file names

This example lists matching log file names for the specified DB instance, file name pattern, last write date in POSIX time with milleseconds, and minimum file size.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBLogFilesInput{
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		FileLastWritten:      aws.Int64(1470873600000),
		FileSize:             aws.Int64(0),
		FilenameContains:     aws.String("error"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBLogFiles(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesPages(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeDBLogFilesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBLogFiles operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeDBLogFiles method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBLogFiles operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeDBLogFilesPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, fn func(*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeDBLogFilesPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBLogFilesPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBLogFilesOutput)

DescribeDBLogFilesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBLogFiles operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBLogFiles for more information on using the DescribeDBLogFiles API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBLogFilesRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBLogFilesRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBLogFiles

func (*RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBLogFilesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBLogFilesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBLogFilesOutput, error)

DescribeDBLogFilesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBLogFiles with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBLogFiles for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroups

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroups(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeDBParameterGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of DBParameterGroup descriptions. If a DBParameterGroupName is specified, the list will contain only the description of the specified DB parameter group.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBParameterGroups for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameterGroups

Example (Shared00)

To list information about DB parameter groups

This example lists information about the specified DB parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput{
		DBParameterGroupName: aws.String("mymysqlparametergroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBParameterGroups(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBParameterGroups operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeDBParameterGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBParameterGroups operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeDBParameterGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBParameterGroupsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput)

DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBParameterGroups operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBParameterGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBParameterGroups API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBParameterGroupsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameterGroups

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameterGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParameterGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBParameterGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeDBParameterGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBParameterGroups with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBParameterGroups for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParameters

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParameters(input *DescribeDBParametersInput) (*DescribeDBParametersOutput, error)

DescribeDBParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns the detailed parameter list for a particular DB parameter group.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBParameters for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameters

Example (Shared00)

To list information about DB parameters

This example lists information for up to the first 20 system parameters for the specified DB parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBParametersInput{
		DBParameterGroupName: aws.String("mymysqlparametergroup"),
		MaxRecords:           aws.Int64(20),
		Source:               aws.String("system"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBParameters(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParametersPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersPages(input *DescribeDBParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParametersOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeDBParametersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBParameters operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeDBParameters method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBParameters operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeDBParametersPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeDBParametersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeDBParametersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeDBParametersPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBParametersPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParametersRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersRequest(input *DescribeDBParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBParametersOutput)

DescribeDBParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBParameters operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBParameters for more information on using the DescribeDBParameters API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBParametersRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBParametersRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBParameters

func (*RDS) DescribeDBParametersWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBParametersOutput, error)

DescribeDBParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeDBParameters with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBParameters for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroups

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroups(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeDBSecurityGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of DBSecurityGroup descriptions. If a DBSecurityGroupName is specified, the list will contain only the descriptions of the specified DB security group.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBSecurityGroups for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSecurityGroups

Example (Shared00)

To list DB security group settings

This example lists settings for the specified security group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput{
		DBSecurityGroupName: aws.String("mydbsecuritygroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBSecurityGroups(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeDBSecurityGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSecurityGroupsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput)

DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBSecurityGroups operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBSecurityGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBSecurityGroups API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBSecurityGroupsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSecurityGroups

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSecurityGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSecurityGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSecurityGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeDBSecurityGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSecurityGroups with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBSecurityGroups for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes(input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput, error)

DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of DB snapshot attribute names and values for a manual DB snapshot.

When sharing snapshots with other AWS accounts, DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes returns the restore attribute and a list of IDs for the AWS accounts that are authorized to copy or restore the manual DB snapshot. If all is included in the list of values for the restore attribute, then the manual DB snapshot is public and can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts.

To add or remove access for an AWS account to copy or restore a manual DB snapshot, or to make the manual DB snapshot public or private, use the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API action.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes

Example (Shared00)

To list DB snapshot attributes

This example lists attributes for the specified DB snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput{
		DBSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbsnapshot"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput)

DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for more information on using the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesOutput, error)

DescribeDBSnapshotAttributesWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSnapshots

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshots(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) (*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, error)

DescribeDBSnapshots API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns information about DB snapshots. This API action supports pagination.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBSnapshots for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshots

Example (Shared00)

To list DB snapshot attributes

This example lists all manually-created, shared snapshots for the specified DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBSnapshotsInput{
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		IncludePublic:        aws.Bool(false),
		IncludeShared:        aws.Bool(true),
		SnapshotType:         aws.String("manual"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBSnapshots(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsPages(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeDBSnapshotsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSnapshots operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeDBSnapshots method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSnapshots operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeDBSnapshotsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeDBSnapshotsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSnapshotsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput)

DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBSnapshots operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBSnapshots for more information on using the DescribeDBSnapshots API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBSnapshotsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSnapshots

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSnapshotsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSnapshotsOutput, error)

DescribeDBSnapshotsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSnapshots with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBSnapshots for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroups

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroups(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeDBSubnetGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of DBSubnetGroup descriptions. If a DBSubnetGroupName is specified, the list will contain only the descriptions of the specified DBSubnetGroup.

For an overview of CIDR ranges, go to the Wikipedia Tutorial (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Classless_Inter-Domain_Routing).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeDBSubnetGroups for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSubnetGroups

Example (Shared00)

To list information about DB subnet groups

This example lists information about the specified DB subnet group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput{
		DBSubnetGroupName: aws.String("mydbsubnetgroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeDBSubnetGroups(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeDBSubnetGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeDBSubnetGroupsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput)

DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeDBSubnetGroups operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeDBSubnetGroups for more information on using the DescribeDBSubnetGroups API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeDBSubnetGroupsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeDBSubnetGroups

func (*RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeDBSubnetGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSubnetGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeDBSubnetGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeDBSubnetGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeDBSubnetGroups with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeDBSubnetGroups for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters

func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters(input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput, error)

DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns the default engine and system parameter information for the cluster database engine.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters

Example (Shared00)

To list default parameters for a DB cluster engine

This example lists default parameters for the specified DB cluster engine.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput{
		DBParameterGroupFamily: aws.String("aurora5.6"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput)

DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for more information on using the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters

func (*RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersOutput, error)

DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeEngineDefaultClusterParameters for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParameters

func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParameters(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, error)

DescribeEngineDefaultParameters API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns the default engine and system parameter information for the specified database engine.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultParameters

Example (Shared00)

To list default parameters for a DB engine

This example lists default parameters for the specified DB engine.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput{
		DBParameterGroupFamily: aws.String("mysql5.6"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeEngineDefaultParameters(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, fn func(*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPagesWithContext same as DescribeEngineDefaultParametersPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput)

DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for more information on using the DescribeEngineDefaultParameters API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeEngineDefaultParametersRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEngineDefaultParameters

func (*RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeEngineDefaultParametersWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEngineDefaultParametersInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEngineDefaultParametersOutput, error)

DescribeEngineDefaultParametersWithContext is the same as DescribeEngineDefaultParameters with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeEngineDefaultParameters for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeEventCategories

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategories(input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput, error)

DescribeEventCategories API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Displays a list of categories for all event source types, or, if specified, for a specified source type. You can see a list of the event categories and source types in the Events (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html) topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeEventCategories for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventCategories

Example (Shared00)

To list event categories.

This example lists all DB instance event categories.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeEventCategoriesInput{
		SourceType: aws.String("db-instance"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeEventCategories(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeEventCategoriesRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventCategoriesOutput)

DescribeEventCategoriesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeEventCategories operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeEventCategories for more information on using the DescribeEventCategories API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeEventCategoriesRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeEventCategoriesRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventCategories

func (*RDS) DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventCategoriesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventCategoriesOutput, error)

DescribeEventCategoriesWithContext is the same as DescribeEventCategories with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeEventCategories for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptions

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptions(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, error)

DescribeEventSubscriptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Lists all the subscription descriptions for a customer account. The description for a subscription includes SubscriptionName, SNSTopicARN, CustomerID, SourceType, SourceID, CreationTime, and Status.

If you specify a SubscriptionName, lists the description for that subscription.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeEventSubscriptions for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound" The subscription name does not exist.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventSubscriptions

Example (Shared00)

To list information about DB event notification subscriptions

This example lists information for the specified DB event notification subscription.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput{
		SubscriptionName: aws.String("mymysqleventsubscription"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeEventSubscriptions(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEventSubscriptions operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeEventSubscriptions method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEventSubscriptions operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeEventSubscriptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeEventSubscriptionsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput)

DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeEventSubscriptions operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeEventSubscriptions for more information on using the DescribeEventSubscriptions API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeEventSubscriptionsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEventSubscriptions

func (*RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventSubscriptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventSubscriptionsOutput, error)

DescribeEventSubscriptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeEventSubscriptions with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeEventSubscriptions for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeEvents

func (c *RDS) DescribeEvents(input *DescribeEventsInput) (*DescribeEventsOutput, error)

DescribeEvents API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns events related to DB instances, DB security groups, DB snapshots, and DB parameter groups for the past 14 days. Events specific to a particular DB instance, DB security group, database snapshot, or DB parameter group can be obtained by providing the name as a parameter. By default, the past hour of events are returned.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeEvents for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEvents

Example (Shared00)

To list information about events

This example lists information for all backup-related events for the specified DB instance for the past 7 days (7 days * 24 hours * 60 minutes = 10,080 minutes).

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeEventsInput{
		Duration: aws.Int64(10080),
		EventCategories: []*string{
			aws.String("backup"),
		},
		SourceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		SourceType:       aws.String("db-instance"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeEvents(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeEventsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsPages(input *DescribeEventsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeEventsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeEvents operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeEvents method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeEvents operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeEventsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeEventsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeEventsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventsInput, fn func(*DescribeEventsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeEventsPagesWithContext same as DescribeEventsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeEventsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsRequest(input *DescribeEventsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeEventsOutput)

DescribeEventsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeEvents operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeEvents for more information on using the DescribeEvents API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeEventsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeEventsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeEvents

func (*RDS) DescribeEventsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeEventsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeEventsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeEventsOutput, error)

DescribeEventsWithContext is the same as DescribeEvents with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeEvents for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptions

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptions(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, error)

DescribeOptionGroupOptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Describes all available options.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeOptionGroupOptions for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroupOptions

Example (Shared00)

To list information about DB option group options

This example lists information for all option group options for the specified DB engine.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput{
		EngineName:         aws.String("mysql"),
		MajorEngineVersion: aws.String("5.6"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeOptionGroupOptions(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeOptionGroupOptions method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOptionGroupOptionsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput)

DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeOptionGroupOptions operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeOptionGroupOptions for more information on using the DescribeOptionGroupOptions API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeOptionGroupOptionsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroupOptions

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupOptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupOptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOptionGroupOptionsOutput, error)

DescribeOptionGroupOptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeOptionGroupOptions with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeOptionGroupOptions for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroups

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroups(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) (*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeOptionGroups API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Describes the available option groups.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeOptionGroups for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroups

Example (Shared00)

To list information about DB option groups

This example lists information for all option groups for the specified DB engine.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeOptionGroupsInput{
		EngineName:         aws.String("mysql"),
		MajorEngineVersion: aws.String("5.6"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeOptionGroups(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsPages(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeOptionGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOptionGroups operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeOptionGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOptionGroups operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeOptionGroupsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, fn func(*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeOptionGroupsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOptionGroupsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOptionGroupsOutput)

DescribeOptionGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeOptionGroups operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeOptionGroups for more information on using the DescribeOptionGroups API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeOptionGroupsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeOptionGroupsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOptionGroups

func (*RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeOptionGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOptionGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOptionGroupsOutput, error)

DescribeOptionGroupsWithContext is the same as DescribeOptionGroups with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeOptionGroups for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions

func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, error)

DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of orderable DB instance options for the specified engine.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions

Example (Shared00)

To list information about orderable DB instance options

This example lists information for all orderable DB instance options for the specified DB engine, engine version, DB instance class, license model, and VPC settings.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput{
		DBInstanceClass: aws.String("db.t2.micro"),
		Engine:          aws.String("mysql"),
		EngineVersion:   aws.String("5.6.27"),
		LicenseModel:    aws.String("general-public-license"),
		Vpc:             aws.Bool(true),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, fn func(*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPagesWithContext same as DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput)

DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for more information on using the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions

func (*RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsOutput, error)

DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptionsWithContext is the same as DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeOrderableDBInstanceOptions for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActions

func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActions(input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput, error)

DescribePendingMaintenanceActions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of resources (for example, DB instances) that have at least one pending maintenance action.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault "ResourceNotFoundFault" The specified resource ID was not found.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribePendingMaintenanceActions

Example (Shared00)

To list information about pending maintenance actions

This example lists information for all pending maintenance actions for the specified DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput{
		ResourceIdentifier: aws.String("arn:aws:rds:us-east-1:992648334831:db:mymysqlinstance"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribePendingMaintenanceActions(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeResourceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput)

DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for more information on using the DescribePendingMaintenanceActions API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribePendingMaintenanceActions

func (*RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsOutput, error)

DescribePendingMaintenanceActionsWithContext is the same as DescribePendingMaintenanceActions with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribePendingMaintenanceActions for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstances

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstances(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, error)

DescribeReservedDBInstances API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns information about reserved DB instances for this account, or about a specified reserved DB instance.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeReservedDBInstances for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstanceNotFound" The specified reserved DB Instance not found.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstances

Example (Shared00)

To list information about reserved DB instances

This example lists information for all reserved DB instances for the specified DB instance class, duration, product, offering type, and availability zone settings.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput{
		DBInstanceClass:    aws.String("db.t2.micro"),
		Duration:           aws.String("1y"),
		MultiAZ:            aws.Bool(false),
		OfferingType:       aws.String("No Upfront"),
		ProductDescription: aws.String("mysql"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeReservedDBInstances(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, error)

DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Lists available reserved DB instance offerings.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFound" Specified offering does not exist.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings

Example (Shared00)

To list information about reserved DB instance offerings

This example lists information for all reserved DB instance offerings for the specified DB instance class, duration, product, offering type, and availability zone settings.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput{
		DBInstanceClass:    aws.String("db.t2.micro"),
		Duration:           aws.String("1y"),
		MultiAZ:            aws.Bool(false),
		OfferingType:       aws.String("No Upfront"),
		ProductDescription: aws.String("mysql"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPagesWithContext same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput)

DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for more information on using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsOutput, error)

DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferingsWithContext is the same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool) error

DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages iterates over the pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstances operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DescribeReservedDBInstances method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeReservedDBInstances operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages(params,
    func(page *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, fn func(*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DescribeReservedDBInstancesPagesWithContext same as DescribeReservedDBInstancesPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput)

DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeReservedDBInstances operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeReservedDBInstances for more information on using the DescribeReservedDBInstances API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeReservedDBInstancesRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeReservedDBInstances

func (*RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeReservedDBInstancesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservedDBInstancesInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservedDBInstancesOutput, error)

DescribeReservedDBInstancesWithContext is the same as DescribeReservedDBInstances with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeReservedDBInstances for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeSourceRegions

func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegions(input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) (*DescribeSourceRegionsOutput, error)

DescribeSourceRegions API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Returns a list of the source AWS Regions where the current AWS Region can create a Read Replica or copy a DB snapshot from. This API action supports pagination.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeSourceRegions for usage and error information. See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeSourceRegions

Example (Shared00)

To describe source regions

To list the AWS regions where a Read Replica can be created.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DescribeSourceRegionsInput{}

	result, err := svc.DescribeSourceRegions(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DescribeSourceRegionsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeSourceRegionsOutput)

DescribeSourceRegionsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeSourceRegions operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeSourceRegions for more information on using the DescribeSourceRegions API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeSourceRegionsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeSourceRegionsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeSourceRegions

func (*RDS) DescribeSourceRegionsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeSourceRegionsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeSourceRegionsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeSourceRegionsOutput, error)

DescribeSourceRegionsWithContext is the same as DescribeSourceRegions with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeSourceRegions for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications

func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications(input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput, error)

DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

You can call DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications to learn what modifications you can make to your DB instance. You can use this information when you call ModifyDBInstance.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications

func (*RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest

func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput)

DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for more information on using the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest method.
req, resp := client.DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications

func (*RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsWithContext

func (c *RDS) DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsOutput, error)

DescribeValidDBInstanceModificationsWithContext is the same as DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortion

func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortion(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, error)

DownloadDBLogFilePortion API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Downloads all or a portion of the specified log file, up to 1 MB in size.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation DownloadDBLogFilePortion for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBLogFileNotFoundFault "DBLogFileNotFoundFault" LogFileName does not refer to an existing DB log file.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DownloadDBLogFilePortion

Example (Shared00)

To list information about DB log files

This example lists information for the specified log file for the specified DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput{
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		LogFileName:          aws.String("mysqlUpgrade"),
	}

	result, err := svc.DownloadDBLogFilePortion(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBLogFileNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBLogFileNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages

func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, fn func(*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, bool) bool) error

DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages iterates over the pages of a DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation, calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop iterating, return false from the fn function.

See DownloadDBLogFilePortion method for more information on how to use this operation.

Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.

// Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation.
pageNum := 0
err := client.DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages(params,
    func(page *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
        pageNum++
        fmt.Println(page)
        return pageNum <= 3
    })

func (*RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext

func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, fn func(*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error

DownloadDBLogFilePortionPagesWithContext same as DownloadDBLogFilePortionPages except it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest

func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput) (req *request.Request, output *DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput)

DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the DownloadDBLogFilePortion operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See DownloadDBLogFilePortion for more information on using the DownloadDBLogFilePortion API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest method.
req, resp := client.DownloadDBLogFilePortionRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/DownloadDBLogFilePortion

func (*RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionWithContext

func (c *RDS) DownloadDBLogFilePortionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DownloadDBLogFilePortionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DownloadDBLogFilePortionOutput, error)

DownloadDBLogFilePortionWithContext is the same as DownloadDBLogFilePortion with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See DownloadDBLogFilePortion for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) FailoverDBCluster

func (c *RDS) FailoverDBCluster(input *FailoverDBClusterInput) (*FailoverDBClusterOutput, error)

FailoverDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Forces a failover for a DB cluster.

A failover for a DB cluster promotes one of the Aurora Replicas (read-only instances) in the DB cluster to be the primary instance (the cluster writer).

Amazon Aurora will automatically fail over to an Aurora Replica, if one exists, when the primary instance fails. You can force a failover when you want to simulate a failure of a primary instance for testing. Because each instance in a DB cluster has its own endpoint address, you will need to clean up and re-establish any existing connections that use those endpoint addresses when the failover is complete.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation FailoverDBCluster for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/FailoverDBCluster

Example (Shared00)

To perform a failover for a DB cluster

This example performs a failover for the specified DB cluster to the specified DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.FailoverDBClusterInput{
		DBClusterIdentifier:        aws.String("myaurorainstance-cluster"),
		TargetDBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("myaurorareplica"),
	}

	result, err := svc.FailoverDBCluster(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) FailoverDBClusterRequest

func (c *RDS) FailoverDBClusterRequest(input *FailoverDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *FailoverDBClusterOutput)

FailoverDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the FailoverDBCluster operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See FailoverDBCluster for more information on using the FailoverDBCluster API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the FailoverDBClusterRequest method.
req, resp := client.FailoverDBClusterRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/FailoverDBCluster

func (*RDS) FailoverDBClusterWithContext

func (c *RDS) FailoverDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *FailoverDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*FailoverDBClusterOutput, error)

FailoverDBClusterWithContext is the same as FailoverDBCluster with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See FailoverDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ListTagsForResource

func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResource(input *ListTagsForResourceInput) (*ListTagsForResourceOutput, error)

ListTagsForResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Lists all tags on an Amazon RDS resource.

For an overview on tagging an Amazon RDS resource, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ListTagsForResource for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ListTagsForResource

Example (Shared00)

To list information about tags associated with a resource

This example lists information about all tags associated with the specified DB option group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ListTagsForResourceInput{
		ResourceName: aws.String("arn:aws:rds:us-east-1:992648334831:og:mymysqloptiongroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.ListTagsForResource(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ListTagsForResourceRequest

func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResourceRequest(input *ListTagsForResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListTagsForResourceOutput)

ListTagsForResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ListTagsForResource operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ListTagsForResource for more information on using the ListTagsForResource API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ListTagsForResourceRequest method.
req, resp := client.ListTagsForResourceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ListTagsForResource

func (*RDS) ListTagsForResourceWithContext

func (c *RDS) ListTagsForResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListTagsForResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListTagsForResourceOutput, error)

ListTagsForResourceWithContext is the same as ListTagsForResource with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ListTagsForResource for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyDBCluster

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBCluster(input *ModifyDBClusterInput) (*ModifyDBClusterOutput, error)

ModifyDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modify a setting for an Amazon Aurora DB cluster. You can change one or more database configuration parameters by specifying these parameters and the new values in the request. For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyDBCluster for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault" The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound" DBClusterParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB Cluster parameter group.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState" The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault" User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBCluster

Example (Shared00)

To change DB cluster settings

This example changes the specified settings for the specified DB cluster.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyDBClusterInput{
		ApplyImmediately:           aws.Bool(true),
		DBClusterIdentifier:        aws.String("mydbcluster"),
		MasterUserPassword:         aws.String("mynewpassword"),
		NewDBClusterIdentifier:     aws.String("mynewdbcluster"),
		PreferredBackupWindow:      aws.String("04:00-04:30"),
		PreferredMaintenanceWindow: aws.String("Tue:05:00-Tue:05:30"),
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyDBCluster(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup(input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error)

ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modifies the parameters of a DB cluster parameter group. To modify more than one parameter, submit a list of the following: ParameterName, ParameterValue, and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified in a single request.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Changes to dynamic parameters are applied immediately. Changes to static parameters require a reboot without failover to the DB cluster associated with the parameter group before the change can take effect.

After you create a DB cluster parameter group, you should wait at least 5 minutes before creating your first DB cluster that uses that DB cluster parameter group as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete the create action before the parameter group is used as the default for a new DB cluster. This is especially important for parameters that are critical when creating the default database for a DB cluster, such as the character set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter. You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/) or the DescribeDBClusterParameters command to verify that your DB cluster parameter group has been created or modified.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState" The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group is in this state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To change DB cluster parameter group settings

This example immediately changes the specified setting for the specified DB cluster parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput{
		DBClusterParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup"),
		Parameters: []*rds.Parameter{
			{
				ApplyMethod:    aws.String("immediate"),
				ParameterName:  aws.String("time_zone"),
				ParameterValue: aws.String("America/Phoenix"),
			},
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage)

ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup

func (*RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error)

ModifyDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyDBClusterRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBClusterOutput)

ModifyDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyDBCluster operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyDBCluster for more information on using the ModifyDBCluster API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBCluster

func (*RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute(input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput, error)

ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Adds an attribute and values to, or removes an attribute and values from, a manual DB cluster snapshot.

To share a manual DB cluster snapshot with other AWS accounts, specify restore as the AttributeName and use the ValuesToAdd parameter to add a list of IDs of the AWS accounts that are authorized to restore the manual DB cluster snapshot. Use the value all to make the manual DB cluster snapshot public, which means that it can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts. Do not add the all value for any manual DB cluster snapshots that contain private information that you don't want available to all AWS accounts. If a manual DB cluster snapshot is encrypted, it can be shared, but only by specifying a list of authorized AWS account IDs for the ValuesToAdd parameter. You can't use all as a value for that parameter in this case.

To view which AWS accounts have access to copy or restore a manual DB cluster snapshot, or whether a manual DB cluster snapshot public or private, use the DescribeDBClusterSnapshotAttributes API action.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault" DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault" The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.

  • ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SharedSnapshotQuotaExceeded" You have exceeded the maximum number of accounts that you can share a manual DB snapshot with.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute

Example (Shared00)

To add or remove access to a manual DB cluster snapshot

The following example gives two AWS accounts access to a manual DB cluster snapshot and ensures that the DB cluster snapshot is private by removing the value "all".

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput{
		AttributeName:               aws.String("restore"),
		DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("manual-cluster-snapshot1"),
		ValuesToAdd: []*string{
			aws.String("123451234512"),
			aws.String("123456789012"),
		},
		ValuesToRemove: []*string{
			aws.String("all"),
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput)

ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for more information on using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute

func (*RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeOutput, error)

ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttributeWithContext is the same as ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyDBClusterSnapshotAttribute for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyDBClusterWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBClusterOutput, error)

ModifyDBClusterWithContext is the same as ModifyDBCluster with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyDBInstance

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstance(input *ModifyDBInstanceInput) (*ModifyDBInstanceOutput, error)

ModifyDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modifies settings for a DB instance. You can change one or more database configuration parameters by specifying these parameters and the new values in the request. To learn what modifications you can make to your DB instance, call DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications before you call ModifyDBInstance.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyDBInstance for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState" The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists" User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity" Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault" Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeDBUpgradeDependencyFailureFault "DBUpgradeDependencyFailure" The DB upgrade failed because a resource the DB depends on could not be modified.

  • ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported" StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified DB security group.

    RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your behalf.

  • ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault "CertificateNotFound" CertificateIdentifier does not refer to an existing certificate.

  • ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault" Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBInstance

Example (Shared00)

To change DB instance settings

This example immediately changes the specified settings for the specified DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyDBInstanceInput{
		AllocatedStorage:           aws.Int64(10),
		ApplyImmediately:           aws.Bool(true),
		BackupRetentionPeriod:      aws.Int64(1),
		DBInstanceClass:            aws.String("db.t2.small"),
		DBInstanceIdentifier:       aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		MasterUserPassword:         aws.String("mynewpassword"),
		PreferredBackupWindow:      aws.String("04:00-04:30"),
		PreferredMaintenanceWindow: aws.String("Tue:05:00-Tue:05:30"),
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyDBInstance(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBUpgradeDependencyFailureFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBUpgradeDependencyFailureFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeCertificateNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyDBInstanceRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstanceRequest(input *ModifyDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBInstanceOutput)

ModifyDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyDBInstance operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyDBInstance for more information on using the ModifyDBInstance API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyDBInstanceRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyDBInstanceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBInstance

func (*RDS) ModifyDBInstanceWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBInstanceOutput, error)

ModifyDBInstanceWithContext is the same as ModifyDBInstance with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroup(input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error)

ModifyDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modifies the parameters of a DB parameter group. To modify more than one parameter, submit a list of the following: ParameterName, ParameterValue, and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters can be modified in a single request.

Changes to dynamic parameters are applied immediately. Changes to static parameters require a reboot without failover to the DB instance associated with the parameter group before the change can take effect.

After you modify a DB parameter group, you should wait at least 5 minutes before creating your first DB instance that uses that DB parameter group as the default parameter group. This allows Amazon RDS to fully complete the modify action before the parameter group is used as the default for a new DB instance. This is especially important for parameters that are critical when creating the default database for a DB instance, such as the character set for the default database defined by the character_set_database parameter. You can use the Parameter Groups option of the Amazon RDS console (https://console.aws.amazon.com/rds/) or the DescribeDBParameters command to verify that your DB parameter group has been created or modified.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState" The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group is in this state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To change DB parameter group settings

This example immediately changes the specified setting for the specified DB parameter group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyDBParameterGroupInput{
		DBParameterGroupName: aws.String("mymysqlparametergroup"),
		Parameters: []*rds.Parameter{
			{
				ApplyMethod:    aws.String("immediate"),
				ParameterName:  aws.String("time_zone"),
				ParameterValue: aws.String("America/Phoenix"),
			},
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyDBParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBParameterGroupNameMessage)

ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyDBParameterGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyDBParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBParameterGroup

func (*RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error)

ModifyDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSnapshot

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshot(input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) (*ModifyDBSnapshotOutput, error)

ModifyDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Updates a manual DB snapshot, which can be encrypted or not encrypted, with a new engine version.

Amazon RDS supports upgrading DB snapshots for MySQL and Oracle.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyDBSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshot

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute(input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput, error)

ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Adds an attribute and values to, or removes an attribute and values from, a manual DB snapshot.

To share a manual DB snapshot with other AWS accounts, specify restore as the AttributeName and use the ValuesToAdd parameter to add a list of IDs of the AWS accounts that are authorized to restore the manual DB snapshot. Uses the value all to make the manual DB snapshot public, which means it can be copied or restored by all AWS accounts. Do not add the all value for any manual DB snapshots that contain private information that you don't want available to all AWS accounts. If the manual DB snapshot is encrypted, it can be shared, but only by specifying a list of authorized AWS account IDs for the ValuesToAdd parameter. You can't use all as a value for that parameter in this case.

To view which AWS accounts have access to copy or restore a manual DB snapshot, or whether a manual DB snapshot public or private, use the DescribeDBSnapshotAttributes API action.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState" The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SharedSnapshotQuotaExceeded" You have exceeded the maximum number of accounts that you can share a manual DB snapshot with.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute

Example (Shared00)

To change DB snapshot attributes

This example adds the specified attribute for the specified DB snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput{
		AttributeName:        aws.String("restore"),
		DBSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("mydbsnapshot"),
		ValuesToAdd: []*string{
			aws.String("all"),
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSharedSnapshotQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput)

ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for more information on using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeOutput, error)

ModifyDBSnapshotAttributeWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyDBSnapshotAttribute for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSnapshotOutput)

ModifyDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyDBSnapshot for more information on using the ModifyDBSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyDBSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSnapshot

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSnapshotOutput, error)

ModifyDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroup

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroup(input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput, error)

ModifyDBSubnetGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modifies an existing DB subnet group. DB subnet groups must contain at least one subnet in at least two AZs in the AWS Region.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyDBSubnetGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault "DBSubnetQuotaExceededFault" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of subnets in a DB subnet groups.

  • ErrCodeSubnetAlreadyInUse "SubnetAlreadyInUse" The DB subnet is already in use in the Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSubnetGroup

Example (Shared00)

To change DB subnet group settings

This example changes the specified setting for the specified DB subnet group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput{
		DBSubnetGroupName: aws.String("mydbsubnetgroup"),
		SubnetIds: []*string{
			aws.String("subnet-70e1975a"),
			aws.String("subnet-747a5c49"),
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyDBSubnetGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSubnetAlreadyInUse:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubnetAlreadyInUse, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput)

ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyDBSubnetGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyDBSubnetGroup for more information on using the ModifyDBSubnetGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyDBSubnetGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyDBSubnetGroup

func (*RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyDBSubnetGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyDBSubnetGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyDBSubnetGroupOutput, error)

ModifyDBSubnetGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyDBSubnetGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyDBSubnetGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyEventSubscription

func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscription(input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput, error)

ModifyEventSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modifies an existing RDS event notification subscription. Note that you can't modify the source identifiers using this call; to change source identifiers for a subscription, use the AddSourceIdentifierToSubscription and RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription calls.

You can see a list of the event categories for a given SourceType in the Events (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Events.html) topic in the Amazon RDS User Guide or by using the DescribeEventCategories action.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyEventSubscription for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault "EventSubscriptionQuotaExceeded" You have reached the maximum number of event subscriptions.

  • ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound" The subscription name does not exist.

  • ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault "SNSInvalidTopic" SNS has responded that there is a problem with the SND topic specified.

  • ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault "SNSNoAuthorization" You do not have permission to publish to the SNS topic ARN.

  • ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault "SNSTopicArnNotFound" The SNS topic ARN does not exist.

  • ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault "SubscriptionCategoryNotFound" The supplied category does not exist.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyEventSubscription

Example (Shared00)

To change event notification subscription settings

This example changes the specified setting for the specified event notification subscription.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyEventSubscriptionInput{
		Enabled: aws.Bool(true),
		EventCategories: []*string{
			aws.String("deletion"),
			aws.String("low storage"),
		},
		SourceType:       aws.String("db-instance"),
		SubscriptionName: aws.String("mymysqleventsubscription"),
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyEventSubscription(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeEventSubscriptionQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSNSInvalidTopicFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSNSNoAuthorizationFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSNSTopicArnNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionCategoryNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput)

ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyEventSubscription operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyEventSubscription for more information on using the ModifyEventSubscription API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyEventSubscriptionRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyEventSubscription

func (*RDS) ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyEventSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyEventSubscriptionOutput, error)

ModifyEventSubscriptionWithContext is the same as ModifyEventSubscription with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyEventSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ModifyOptionGroup

func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroup(input *ModifyOptionGroupInput) (*ModifyOptionGroupOutput, error)

ModifyOptionGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modifies an existing option group.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ModifyOptionGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault "InvalidOptionGroupStateFault" The option group is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyOptionGroup

Example (Shared00)

To modify an option group

The following example adds an option to an option group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ModifyOptionGroupInput{
		ApplyImmediately: aws.Bool(true),
		OptionGroupName:  aws.String("myawsuser-og02"),
		OptionsToInclude: []*rds.OptionConfiguration{
			{
				DBSecurityGroupMemberships: []*string{
					aws.String("default"),
				},
				OptionName: aws.String("MEMCACHED"),
			},
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.ModifyOptionGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidOptionGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ModifyOptionGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroupRequest(input *ModifyOptionGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *ModifyOptionGroupOutput)

ModifyOptionGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ModifyOptionGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ModifyOptionGroup for more information on using the ModifyOptionGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ModifyOptionGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.ModifyOptionGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ModifyOptionGroup

func (*RDS) ModifyOptionGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) ModifyOptionGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ModifyOptionGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ModifyOptionGroupOutput, error)

ModifyOptionGroupWithContext is the same as ModifyOptionGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ModifyOptionGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) PromoteReadReplica

func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplica(input *PromoteReadReplicaInput) (*PromoteReadReplicaOutput, error)

PromoteReadReplica API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Promotes a Read Replica DB instance to a standalone DB instance.

Backup duration is a function of the amount of changes to the database since the previous backup. If you plan to promote a Read Replica to a standalone instance, we recommend that you enable backups and complete at least one backup prior to promotion. In addition, a Read Replica cannot be promoted to a standalone instance when it is in the backing-up status. If you have enabled backups on your Read Replica, configure the automated backup window so that daily backups do not interfere with Read Replica promotion.

This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation PromoteReadReplica for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplica

Example (Shared00)

To promote a read replica

This example promotes the specified read replica and sets its backup retention period and preferred backup window.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.PromoteReadReplicaInput{
		BackupRetentionPeriod: aws.Int64(1),
		DBInstanceIdentifier:  aws.String("mydbreadreplica"),
		PreferredBackupWindow: aws.String("03:30-04:00"),
	}

	result, err := svc.PromoteReadReplica(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster

func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster(input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput, error)

PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Promotes a Read Replica DB cluster to a standalone DB cluster.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster

func (*RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest

func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput)

PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for more information on using the PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest method.
req, resp := client.PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster

func (*RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterWithContext

func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterOutput, error)

PromoteReadReplicaDBClusterWithContext is the same as PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See PromoteReadReplicaDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) PromoteReadReplicaRequest

func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaRequest(input *PromoteReadReplicaInput) (req *request.Request, output *PromoteReadReplicaOutput)

PromoteReadReplicaRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the PromoteReadReplica operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See PromoteReadReplica for more information on using the PromoteReadReplica API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the PromoteReadReplicaRequest method.
req, resp := client.PromoteReadReplicaRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PromoteReadReplica

func (*RDS) PromoteReadReplicaWithContext

func (c *RDS) PromoteReadReplicaWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PromoteReadReplicaInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PromoteReadReplicaOutput, error)

PromoteReadReplicaWithContext is the same as PromoteReadReplica with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See PromoteReadReplica for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering

func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering(input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput, error)

PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Purchases a reserved DB instance offering.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault "ReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFound" Specified offering does not exist.

  • ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "ReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExists" User already has a reservation with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceededFault "ReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceeded" Request would exceed the user's DB Instance quota.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering

Example (Shared00)

To purchase a reserved DB instance offering

This example purchases a reserved DB instance offering that matches the specified settings.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput{
		ReservedDBInstanceId:          aws.String("myreservationid"),
		ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId: aws.String("fb29428a-646d-4390-850e-5fe89926e727"),
	}

	result, err := svc.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstancesOfferingNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeReservedDBInstanceQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest

func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput)

PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for more information on using the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest method.
req, resp := client.PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering

func (*RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingWithContext

func (c *RDS) PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingOutput, error)

PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOfferingWithContext is the same as PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RebootDBInstance

func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstance(input *RebootDBInstanceInput) (*RebootDBInstanceOutput, error)

RebootDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

You might need to reboot your DB instance, usually for maintenance reasons. For example, if you make certain modifications, or if you change the DB parameter group associated with the DB instance, you must reboot the instance for the changes to take effect.

Rebooting a DB instance restarts the database engine service. Rebooting a DB instance results in a momentary outage, during which the DB instance status is set to rebooting.

For more information about rebooting, see Rebooting a DB Instance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_RebootInstance.html).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RebootDBInstance for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RebootDBInstance

Example (Shared00)

To reboot a DB instance

This example reboots the specified DB instance without forcing a failover.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.RebootDBInstanceInput{
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		ForceFailover:        aws.Bool(false),
	}

	result, err := svc.RebootDBInstance(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) RebootDBInstanceRequest

func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstanceRequest(input *RebootDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *RebootDBInstanceOutput)

RebootDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RebootDBInstance operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RebootDBInstance for more information on using the RebootDBInstance API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RebootDBInstanceRequest method.
req, resp := client.RebootDBInstanceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RebootDBInstance

func (*RDS) RebootDBInstanceWithContext

func (c *RDS) RebootDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RebootDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RebootDBInstanceOutput, error)

RebootDBInstanceWithContext is the same as RebootDBInstance with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RebootDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBCluster

func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBCluster(input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput, error)

RemoveRoleFromDBCluster API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Disassociates an Identity and Access Management (IAM) role from an Aurora DB cluster. For more information, see Authorizing Amazon Aurora to Access Other AWS Services On Your Behalf (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Authorizing.AWSServices.html).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterRoleNotFoundFault "DBClusterRoleNotFound" The specified IAM role Amazon Resource Name (ARN) is not associated with the specified DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveRoleFromDBCluster

func (*RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest

func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput)

RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RemoveRoleFromDBCluster operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for more information on using the RemoveRoleFromDBCluster API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest method.
req, resp := client.RemoveRoleFromDBClusterRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveRoleFromDBCluster

func (*RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBClusterWithContext

func (c *RDS) RemoveRoleFromDBClusterWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput, error)

RemoveRoleFromDBClusterWithContext is the same as RemoveRoleFromDBCluster with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RemoveRoleFromDBCluster for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription

func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription(input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput, error)

RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Removes a source identifier from an existing RDS event notification subscription.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault "SubscriptionNotFound" The subscription name does not exist.

  • ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault "SourceNotFound" The requested source could not be found.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription

Example (Shared00)

To remove a source identifier from a DB event subscription

This example removes the specified source identifier from the specified DB event subscription.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput{
		SourceIdentifier: aws.String("mymysqlinstance"),
		SubscriptionName: aws.String("myeventsubscription"),
	}

	result, err := svc.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSubscriptionNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeSourceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest

func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput)

RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for more information on using the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest method.
req, resp := client.RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription

func (*RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionWithContext

func (c *RDS) RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput, error)

RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionWithContext is the same as RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscription for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RemoveTagsFromResource

func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResource(input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) (*RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput, error)

RemoveTagsFromResource API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Removes metadata tags from an Amazon RDS resource.

For an overview on tagging an Amazon RDS resource, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Overview.Tagging.html).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RemoveTagsFromResource for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveTagsFromResource

Example (Shared00)

To remove tags from a resource

This example removes the specified tag associated with the specified DB option group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.RemoveTagsFromResourceInput{
		ResourceName: aws.String("arn:aws:rds:us-east-1:992648334831:og:mydboptiongroup"),
		TagKeys: []*string{
			aws.String("MyKey"),
		},
	}

	result, err := svc.RemoveTagsFromResource(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest

func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) (req *request.Request, output *RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput)

RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RemoveTagsFromResource operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RemoveTagsFromResource for more information on using the RemoveTagsFromResource API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest method.
req, resp := client.RemoveTagsFromResourceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RemoveTagsFromResource

func (*RDS) RemoveTagsFromResourceWithContext

func (c *RDS) RemoveTagsFromResourceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput, error)

RemoveTagsFromResourceWithContext is the same as RemoveTagsFromResource with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RemoveTagsFromResource for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroup(input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error)

ResetDBClusterParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modifies the parameters of a DB cluster parameter group to the default value. To reset specific parameters submit a list of the following: ParameterName and ApplyMethod. To reset the entire DB cluster parameter group, specify the DBClusterParameterGroupName and ResetAllParameters parameters.

When resetting the entire group, dynamic parameters are updated immediately and static parameters are set to pending-reboot to take effect on the next DB instance restart or RebootDBInstance request. You must call RebootDBInstance for every DB instance in your DB cluster that you want the updated static parameter to apply to.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState" The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group is in this state.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBClusterParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To reset the values of a DB cluster parameter group

This example resets all parameters for the specified DB cluster parameter group to their default values.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput{
		DBClusterParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbclusterparametergroup"),
		ResetAllParameters:          aws.Bool(true),
	}

	result, err := svc.ResetDBClusterParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage)

ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ResetDBClusterParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for more information on using the ResetDBClusterParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.ResetDBClusterParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBClusterParameterGroup

func (*RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) ResetDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBClusterParameterGroupNameMessage, error)

ResetDBClusterParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ResetDBClusterParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ResetDBClusterParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) ResetDBParameterGroup

func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroup(input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error)

ResetDBParameterGroup API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Modifies the parameters of a DB parameter group to the engine/system default value. To reset specific parameters, provide a list of the following: ParameterName and ApplyMethod. To reset the entire DB parameter group, specify the DBParameterGroup name and ResetAllParameters parameters. When resetting the entire group, dynamic parameters are updated immediately and static parameters are set to pending-reboot to take effect on the next DB instance restart or RebootDBInstance request.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation ResetDBParameterGroup for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault "InvalidDBParameterGroupState" The DB parameter group is in use or is in an invalid state. If you are attempting to delete the parameter group, you cannot delete it when the parameter group is in this state.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBParameterGroup

Example (Shared00)

To reset the values of a DB parameter group

This example resets all parameters for the specified DB parameter group to their default values.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.ResetDBParameterGroupInput{
		DBParameterGroupName: aws.String("mydbparametergroup"),
		ResetAllParameters:   aws.Bool(true),
	}

	result, err := svc.ResetDBParameterGroup(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBParameterGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) ResetDBParameterGroupRequest

func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DBParameterGroupNameMessage)

ResetDBParameterGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the ResetDBParameterGroup operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See ResetDBParameterGroup for more information on using the ResetDBParameterGroup API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the ResetDBParameterGroupRequest method.
req, resp := client.ResetDBParameterGroupRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/ResetDBParameterGroup

func (*RDS) ResetDBParameterGroupWithContext

func (c *RDS) ResetDBParameterGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ResetDBParameterGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DBParameterGroupNameMessage, error)

ResetDBParameterGroupWithContext is the same as ResetDBParameterGroup with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See ResetDBParameterGroup for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3(input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output, error)

RestoreDBClusterFromS3 API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates an Amazon Aurora DB cluster from data stored in an Amazon S3 bucket. Amazon RDS must be authorized to access the Amazon S3 bucket and the data must be created using the Percona XtraBackup utility as described in Migrating Data from MySQL by Using an Amazon S3 Bucket (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Aurora.Migrate.MySQL.html#Aurora.Migrate.MySQL.S3).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault" User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault" User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSubnetGroupStateFault" The DB subnet group cannot be deleted because it is in use.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketFault "InvalidS3BucketFault" The specified Amazon S3 bucket name could not be found or Amazon RDS is not authorized to access the specified Amazon S3 bucket. Verify the SourceS3BucketName and S3IngestionRoleArn values and try again.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBClusterParameterGroupNotFound" DBClusterParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB Cluster parameter group.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity" There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different Availability Zones that have more storage available.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromS3

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output)

RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RestoreDBClusterFromS3 operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterFromS3 API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request method.
req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterFromS3Request(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromS3

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3WithContext

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromS3WithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output, error)

RestoreDBClusterFromS3WithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterFromS3 with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RestoreDBClusterFromS3 for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot(input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput, error)

RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new DB cluster from a DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.

If a DB snapshot is specified, the target DB cluster is created from the source DB snapshot with a default configuration and default security group.

If a DB cluster snapshot is specified, the target DB cluster is created from the source DB cluster restore point with the same configuration as the original source DB cluster, except that the new DB cluster is created with the default security group.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault" User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault" User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault" DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault" The DB cluster does not have enough capacity for the current operation.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity" There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different Availability Zones that have more storage available.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState" The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault" The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault" Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot

Example (Shared00)

To restore an Amazon Aurora DB cluster from a DB cluster snapshot

The following example restores an Amazon Aurora DB cluster from a DB cluster snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput{
		DBClusterIdentifier: aws.String("restored-cluster1"),
		Engine:              aws.String("aurora"),
		SnapshotIdentifier:  aws.String("sample-cluster-snapshot1"),
	}

	result, err := svc.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput)

RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput, error)

RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotWithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime(input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput, error)

RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Restores a DB cluster to an arbitrary point in time. Users can restore to any point in time before LatestRestorableTime for up to BackupRetentionPeriod days. The target DB cluster is created from the source DB cluster with the same configuration as the original DB cluster, except that the new DB cluster is created with the default DB security group.

This action only restores the DB cluster, not the DB instances for that DB cluster. You must invoke the CreateDBInstance action to create DB instances for the restored DB cluster, specifying the identifier of the restored DB cluster in DBClusterIdentifier. You can create DB instances only after the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime action has completed and the DB cluster is available.

For more information on Amazon Aurora, see Aurora on Amazon RDS (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Aurora.html) in the Amazon RDS User Guide.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault "DBClusterAlreadyExistsFault" User already has a DB cluster with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault "DBClusterQuotaExceededFault" User attempted to create a new DB cluster and the user has already reached the maximum allowed DB cluster quota.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault" DBClusterSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster snapshot.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault" The DB cluster does not have enough capacity for the current operation.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault "InsufficientStorageClusterCapacity" There is insufficient storage available for the current action. You may be able to resolve this error by updating your subnet group to use different Availability Zones that have more storage available.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault" The supplied value is not a valid DB cluster snapshot state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState" The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault" Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime

Example (Shared00)

To restore a DB cluster to a point in time.

The following example restores a DB cluster to a new DB cluster at a point in time from the source DB cluster.

package main

import (
	"fmt"
	"time"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func parseTime(layout, value string) *time.Time {
	t, err := time.Parse(layout, value)
	if err != nil {
		panic(err)
	}
	return &t
}

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput{
		DBClusterIdentifier:       aws.String("sample-restored-cluster1"),
		RestoreToTime:             parseTime("2006-01-02T15:04:05Z", "2016-09-13T18:45:00Z"),
		SourceDBClusterIdentifier: aws.String("sample-cluster1"),
	}

	result, err := svc.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBClusterSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBClusterCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientStorageClusterCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput)

RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for more information on using the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest method.
req, resp := client.RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime

func (*RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeWithContext

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput, error)

RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeWithContext is the same as RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput, error)

RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Creates a new DB instance from a DB snapshot. The target database is created from the source database restore point with the most of original configuration with the default security group and the default DB parameter group. By default, the new DB instance is created as a single-AZ deployment except when the instance is a SQL Server instance that has an option group that is associated with mirroring; in this case, the instance becomes a mirrored AZ deployment and not a single-AZ deployment.

If your intent is to replace your original DB instance with the new, restored DB instance, then rename your original DB instance before you call the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot action. RDS doesn't allow two DB instances with the same name. Once you have renamed your original DB instance with a different identifier, then you can pass the original name of the DB instance as the DBInstanceIdentifier in the call to the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot action. The result is that you will replace the original DB instance with the DB instance created from the snapshot.

If you are restoring from a shared manual DB snapshot, the DBSnapshotIdentifier must be the ARN of the shared DB snapshot.

This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL. For Aurora, use RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshot.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists" User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault "DBSnapshotNotFound" DBSnapshotIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB snapshot.

  • ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity" Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault "InvalidDBSnapshotState" The state of the DB snapshot does not allow deletion.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault" Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault" Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported" StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified DB security group.

    RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your behalf.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

  • ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault" Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot

Example (Shared00)

To restore a DB instance from a DB snapshot.

The following example restores a DB instance from a DB snapshot.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput{
		DBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mysqldb-restored"),
		DBSnapshotIdentifier: aws.String("rds:mysqldb-2014-04-22-08-15"),
	}

	result, err := svc.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSnapshotNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSnapshotStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput)

RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest method.
req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotWithContext

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput, error)

RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotWithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshot for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output, error)

RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Amazon Relational Database Service (Amazon RDS) supports importing MySQL databases by using backup files. You can create a backup of your on-premises database, store it on Amazon Simple Storage Service (Amazon S3), and then restore the backup file onto a new Amazon RDS DB instance running MySQL. For more information, see Importing Data into an Amazon RDS MySQL DB Instance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/MySQL.Procedural.Importing.html).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists" User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity" Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeDBParameterGroupNotFoundFault "DBParameterGroupNotFound" DBParameterGroupName does not refer to an existing DB parameter group.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

  • ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeInvalidS3BucketFault "InvalidS3BucketFault" The specified Amazon S3 bucket name could not be found or Amazon RDS is not authorized to access the specified Amazon S3 bucket. Verify the SourceS3BucketName and S3IngestionRoleArn values and try again.

  • ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault" Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported" StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified DB security group.

    RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your behalf.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromS3

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output)

RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request method.
req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Request(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceFromS3

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3WithContext

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceFromS3WithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output, error)

RestoreDBInstanceFromS3WithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RestoreDBInstanceFromS3 for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime(input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput, error)

RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Restores a DB instance to an arbitrary point in time. You can restore to any point in time before the time identified by the LatestRestorableTime property. You can restore to a point up to the number of days specified by the BackupRetentionPeriod property.

The target database is created with most of the original configuration, but in a system-selected availability zone, with the default security group, the default subnet group, and the default DB parameter group. By default, the new DB instance is created as a single-AZ deployment except when the instance is a SQL Server instance that has an option group that is associated with mirroring; in this case, the instance becomes a mirrored deployment and not a single-AZ deployment.

This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL. For Aurora, use RestoreDBClusterToPointInTime.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault "DBInstanceAlreadyExists" User already has a DB instance with the given identifier.

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault "InstanceQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB instances.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity" Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodePointInTimeRestoreNotEnabledFault "PointInTimeRestoreNotEnabled" SourceDBInstanceIdentifier refers to a DB instance with BackupRetentionPeriod equal to 0.

  • ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault "StorageQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed amount of storage available across all DB instances.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault "InvalidRestoreFault" Cannot restore from vpc backup to non-vpc DB instance.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault "ProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault" Provisioned IOPS not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault "OptionGroupNotFoundFault" The specified option group could not be found.

  • ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault "StorageTypeNotSupported" StorageType specified cannot be associated with the DB Instance.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified DB security group.

    RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your behalf.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

  • ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault "DomainNotFoundFault" Domain does not refer to an existing Active Directory Domain.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime

Example (Shared00)

To restore a DB instance to a point in time.

The following example restores a DB instance to a new DB instance at a point in time from the source DB instance.

package main

import (
	"fmt"
	"time"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func parseTime(layout, value string) *time.Time {
	t, err := time.Parse(layout, value)
	if err != nil {
		panic(err)
	}
	return &t
}

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput{
		RestoreTime:                parseTime("2006-01-02T15:04:05Z", "2016-09-13T18:45:00Z"),
		SourceDBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mysql-sample"),
		TargetDBInstanceIdentifier: aws.String("mysql-sample-restored"),
	}

	result, err := svc.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceAlreadyExistsFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInstanceQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodePointInTimeRestoreNotEnabledFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodePointInTimeRestoreNotEnabledFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageQuotaExceededFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidRestoreFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidSubnet, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeProvisionedIopsNotAvailableInAZFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeOptionGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeStorageTypeNotSupportedFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDomainNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) (req *request.Request, output *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput)

RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for more information on using the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest method.
req, resp := client.RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime

func (*RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeWithContext

func (c *RDS) RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput, error)

RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeWithContext is the same as RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTime for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress

func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress(input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error)

RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Revokes ingress from a DBSecurityGroup for previously authorized IP ranges or EC2 or VPC Security Groups. Required parameters for this API are one of CIDRIP, EC2SecurityGroupId for VPC, or (EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId).

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault "DBSecurityGroupNotFound" DBSecurityGroupName does not refer to an existing DB security group.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified DB security group.

    RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your behalf.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault "InvalidDBSecurityGroupState" The state of the DB security group does not allow deletion.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress

Example (Shared00)

To revoke ingress for a DB security group

This example revokes ingress for the specified CIDR block associated with the specified DB security group.

package main

import (
	"fmt"

	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awserr"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/session"
	"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/service/rds"
)

func main() {
	svc := rds.New(session.New())
	input := &rds.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput{
		CIDRIP:              aws.String("203.0.113.5/32"),
		DBSecurityGroupName: aws.String("mydbsecuritygroup"),
	}

	result, err := svc.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress(input)
	if err != nil {
		if aerr, ok := err.(awserr.Error); ok {
			switch aerr.Code() {
			case rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeDBSecurityGroupNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault, aerr.Error())
			case rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault:
				fmt.Println(rds.ErrCodeInvalidDBSecurityGroupStateFault, aerr.Error())
			default:
				fmt.Println(aerr.Error())
			}
		} else {
			// Print the error, cast err to awserr.Error to get the Code and
			// Message from an error.
			fmt.Println(err.Error())
		}
		return
	}

	fmt.Println(result)
}
Output:

func (*RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest

func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) (req *request.Request, output *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput)

RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for more information on using the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest method.
req, resp := client.RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress

func (*RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext

func (c *RDS) RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput, opts ...request.Option) (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput, error)

RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressWithContext is the same as RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngress for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) StartDBInstance

func (c *RDS) StartDBInstance(input *StartDBInstanceInput) (*StartDBInstanceOutput, error)

StartDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Starts a DB instance that was stopped using the AWS console, the stop-db-instance AWS CLI command, or the StopDBInstance action. For more information, see Stopping and Starting a DB instance in the AWS RDS user guide.

This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation StartDBInstance for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeInsufficientDBInstanceCapacityFault "InsufficientDBInstanceCapacity" Specified DB instance class is not available in the specified Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault "DBSubnetGroupNotFoundFault" DBSubnetGroupName does not refer to an existing DB subnet group.

  • ErrCodeDBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs "DBSubnetGroupDoesNotCoverEnoughAZs" Subnets in the DB subnet group should cover at least two Availability Zones unless there is only one Availability Zone.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

  • ErrCodeInvalidSubnet "InvalidSubnet" The requested subnet is invalid, or multiple subnets were requested that are not all in a common VPC.

  • ErrCodeInvalidVPCNetworkStateFault "InvalidVPCNetworkStateFault" DB subnet group does not cover all Availability Zones after it is created because users' change.

  • ErrCodeDBClusterNotFoundFault "DBClusterNotFoundFault" DBClusterIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB cluster.

  • ErrCodeAuthorizationNotFoundFault "AuthorizationNotFound" Specified CIDRIP or EC2 security group is not authorized for the specified DB security group.

    RDS may not also be authorized via IAM to perform necessary actions on your behalf.

  • ErrCodeKMSKeyNotAccessibleFault "KMSKeyNotAccessibleFault" Error accessing KMS key.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StartDBInstance

func (*RDS) StartDBInstanceRequest

func (c *RDS) StartDBInstanceRequest(input *StartDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartDBInstanceOutput)

StartDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the StartDBInstance operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See StartDBInstance for more information on using the StartDBInstance API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the StartDBInstanceRequest method.
req, resp := client.StartDBInstanceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StartDBInstance

func (*RDS) StartDBInstanceWithContext

func (c *RDS) StartDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartDBInstanceOutput, error)

StartDBInstanceWithContext is the same as StartDBInstance with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See StartDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) StopDBInstance

func (c *RDS) StopDBInstance(input *StopDBInstanceInput) (*StopDBInstanceOutput, error)

StopDBInstance API operation for Amazon Relational Database Service.

Stops a DB instance. When you stop a DB instance, Amazon RDS retains the DB instance's metadata, including its endpoint, DB parameter group, and option group membership. Amazon RDS also retains the transaction logs so you can do a point-in-time restore if necessary. For more information, see Stopping and Starting a DB instance in the AWS RDS user guide.

This command doesn't apply to Aurora MySQL and Aurora PostgreSQL.

Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about the error.

See the AWS API reference guide for Amazon Relational Database Service's API operation StopDBInstance for usage and error information.

Returned Error Codes:

  • ErrCodeDBInstanceNotFoundFault "DBInstanceNotFound" DBInstanceIdentifier does not refer to an existing DB instance.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBInstanceStateFault "InvalidDBInstanceState" The specified DB instance is not in the available state.

  • ErrCodeDBSnapshotAlreadyExistsFault "DBSnapshotAlreadyExists" DBSnapshotIdentifier is already used by an existing snapshot.

  • ErrCodeSnapshotQuotaExceededFault "SnapshotQuotaExceeded" Request would result in user exceeding the allowed number of DB snapshots.

  • ErrCodeInvalidDBClusterStateFault "InvalidDBClusterStateFault" The DB cluster is not in a valid state.

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StopDBInstance

func (*RDS) StopDBInstanceRequest

func (c *RDS) StopDBInstanceRequest(input *StopDBInstanceInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopDBInstanceOutput)

StopDBInstanceRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the client's request for the StopDBInstance operation. The "output" return value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes successfuly.

Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service. the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.

See StopDBInstance for more information on using the StopDBInstance API call, and error handling.

This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.

// Example sending a request using the StopDBInstanceRequest method.
req, resp := client.StopDBInstanceRequest(params)

err := req.Send()
if err == nil { // resp is now filled
    fmt.Println(resp)
}

See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/rds-2014-10-31/StopDBInstance

func (*RDS) StopDBInstanceWithContext

func (c *RDS) StopDBInstanceWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopDBInstanceInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopDBInstanceOutput, error)

StopDBInstanceWithContext is the same as StopDBInstance with the addition of the ability to pass a context and additional request options.

See StopDBInstance for details on how to use this API operation.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) WaitUntilDBInstanceAvailable

func (c *RDS) WaitUntilDBInstanceAvailable(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput) error

WaitUntilDBInstanceAvailable uses the Amazon RDS API operation DescribeDBInstances to wait for a condition to be met before returning. If the condition is not met within the max attempt window, an error will be returned.

func (*RDS) WaitUntilDBInstanceAvailableWithContext

func (c *RDS) WaitUntilDBInstanceAvailableWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, opts ...request.WaiterOption) error

WaitUntilDBInstanceAvailableWithContext is an extended version of WaitUntilDBInstanceAvailable. With the support for passing in a context and options to configure the Waiter and the underlying request options.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) WaitUntilDBInstanceDeleted

func (c *RDS) WaitUntilDBInstanceDeleted(input *DescribeDBInstancesInput) error

WaitUntilDBInstanceDeleted uses the Amazon RDS API operation DescribeDBInstances to wait for a condition to be met before returning. If the condition is not met within the max attempt window, an error will be returned.

func (*RDS) WaitUntilDBInstanceDeletedWithContext

func (c *RDS) WaitUntilDBInstanceDeletedWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBInstancesInput, opts ...request.WaiterOption) error

WaitUntilDBInstanceDeletedWithContext is an extended version of WaitUntilDBInstanceDeleted. With the support for passing in a context and options to configure the Waiter and the underlying request options.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) WaitUntilDBSnapshotAvailable

func (c *RDS) WaitUntilDBSnapshotAvailable(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) error

WaitUntilDBSnapshotAvailable uses the Amazon RDS API operation DescribeDBSnapshots to wait for a condition to be met before returning. If the condition is not met within the max attempt window, an error will be returned.

func (*RDS) WaitUntilDBSnapshotAvailableWithContext

func (c *RDS) WaitUntilDBSnapshotAvailableWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.WaiterOption) error

WaitUntilDBSnapshotAvailableWithContext is an extended version of WaitUntilDBSnapshotAvailable. With the support for passing in a context and options to configure the Waiter and the underlying request options.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

func (*RDS) WaitUntilDBSnapshotDeleted

func (c *RDS) WaitUntilDBSnapshotDeleted(input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput) error

WaitUntilDBSnapshotDeleted uses the Amazon RDS API operation DescribeDBSnapshots to wait for a condition to be met before returning. If the condition is not met within the max attempt window, an error will be returned.

func (*RDS) WaitUntilDBSnapshotDeletedWithContext

func (c *RDS) WaitUntilDBSnapshotDeletedWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeDBSnapshotsInput, opts ...request.WaiterOption) error

WaitUntilDBSnapshotDeletedWithContext is an extended version of WaitUntilDBSnapshotDeleted. With the support for passing in a context and options to configure the Waiter and the underlying request options.

The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/ for more information on using Contexts.

type Range

type Range struct {

	// The minimum value in the range.
	From *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The step value for the range. For example, if you have a range of 5,000 to
	// 10,000, with a step value of 1,000, the valid values start at 5,000 and step
	// up by 1,000. Even though 7,500 is within the range, it isn't a valid value
	// for the range. The valid values are 5,000, 6,000, 7,000, 8,000...
	Step *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The maximum value in the range.
	To *int64 `type:"integer"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

A range of integer values.

func (Range) GoString

func (s Range) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Range) SetFrom

func (s *Range) SetFrom(v int64) *Range

SetFrom sets the From field's value.

func (*Range) SetStep

func (s *Range) SetStep(v int64) *Range

SetStep sets the Step field's value.

func (*Range) SetTo

func (s *Range) SetTo(v int64) *Range

SetTo sets the To field's value.

func (Range) String

func (s Range) String() string

String returns the string representation

type RebootDBInstanceInput

type RebootDBInstanceInput struct {

	// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBInstance.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// When true, the reboot is conducted through a MultiAZ failover.
	//
	// Constraint: You can't specify true if the instance is not configured for
	// MultiAZ.
	ForceFailover *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RebootDBInstanceInput) GoString

func (s RebootDBInstanceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RebootDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RebootDBInstanceInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*RebootDBInstanceInput) SetForceFailover

func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) SetForceFailover(v bool) *RebootDBInstanceInput

SetForceFailover sets the ForceFailover field's value.

func (RebootDBInstanceInput) String

func (s RebootDBInstanceInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*RebootDBInstanceInput) Validate

func (s *RebootDBInstanceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RebootDBInstanceOutput

type RebootDBInstanceOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RebootDBInstanceOutput) GoString

func (s RebootDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RebootDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (RebootDBInstanceOutput) String

func (s RebootDBInstanceOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type RecurringCharge

type RecurringCharge struct {

	// The amount of the recurring charge.
	RecurringChargeAmount *float64 `type:"double"`

	// The frequency of the recurring charge.
	RecurringChargeFrequency *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances and DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings actions.

func (RecurringCharge) GoString

func (s RecurringCharge) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeAmount

func (s *RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeAmount(v float64) *RecurringCharge

SetRecurringChargeAmount sets the RecurringChargeAmount field's value.

func (*RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeFrequency

func (s *RecurringCharge) SetRecurringChargeFrequency(v string) *RecurringCharge

SetRecurringChargeFrequency sets the RecurringChargeFrequency field's value.

func (RecurringCharge) String

func (s RecurringCharge) String() string

String returns the string representation

type RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput

type RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster to disassociate the IAM role from.
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the IAM role to disassociate from the Aurora
	// DB cluster, for example arn:aws:iam::123456789012:role/AuroraAccessRole.
	//
	// RoleArn is a required field
	RoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) GoString

func (s RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) SetRoleArn

SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.

func (RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) Validate

func (s *RemoveRoleFromDBClusterInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput

type RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (RemoveRoleFromDBClusterOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput

type RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput struct {

	// The source identifier to be removed from the subscription, such as the DB
	// instance identifier for a DB instance or the name of a security group.
	//
	// SourceIdentifier is a required field
	SourceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the RDS event notification subscription you want to remove a
	// source identifier from.
	//
	// SubscriptionName is a required field
	SubscriptionName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) SetSourceIdentifier

SetSourceIdentifier sets the SourceIdentifier field's value.

func (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) SetSubscriptionName

SetSubscriptionName sets the SubscriptionName field's value.

func (RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput

type RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput struct {

	// Contains the results of a successful invocation of the DescribeEventSubscriptions
	// action.
	EventSubscription *EventSubscription `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) SetEventSubscription

SetEventSubscription sets the EventSubscription field's value.

func (RemoveSourceIdentifierFromSubscriptionOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type RemoveTagsFromResourceInput

type RemoveTagsFromResourceInput struct {

	// The Amazon RDS resource that the tags are removed from. This value is an
	// Amazon Resource Name (ARN). For information about creating an ARN, see  Constructing
	// an RDS Amazon Resource Name (ARN) (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.ARN.html#USER_Tagging.ARN.Constructing).
	//
	// ResourceName is a required field
	ResourceName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The tag key (name) of the tag to be removed.
	//
	// TagKeys is a required field
	TagKeys []*string `type:"list" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) GoString

func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) SetResourceName

SetResourceName sets the ResourceName field's value.

func (*RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) SetTagKeys

SetTagKeys sets the TagKeys field's value.

func (RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) Validate

func (s *RemoveTagsFromResourceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput

type RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) GoString

func (s RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (RemoveTagsFromResourceOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type ReservedDBInstance

type ReservedDBInstance struct {

	// The currency code for the reserved DB instance.
	CurrencyCode *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB instance class for the reserved DB instance.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// The number of reserved DB instances.
	DBInstanceCount *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The duration of the reservation in seconds.
	Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The fixed price charged for this reserved DB instance.
	FixedPrice *float64 `type:"double"`

	// Indicates if the reservation applies to Multi-AZ deployments.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The offering type of this reserved DB instance.
	OfferingType *string `type:"string"`

	// The description of the reserved DB instance.
	ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The recurring price charged to run this reserved DB instance.
	RecurringCharges []*RecurringCharge `locationNameList:"RecurringCharge" type:"list"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the reserved DB instance.
	ReservedDBInstanceArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The unique identifier for the reservation.
	ReservedDBInstanceId *string `type:"string"`

	// The offering identifier.
	ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`

	// The time the reservation started.
	StartTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// The state of the reserved DB instance.
	State *string `type:"string"`

	// The hourly price charged for this reserved DB instance.
	UsagePrice *float64 `type:"double"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstances and PurchaseReservedDBInstancesOffering actions.

func (ReservedDBInstance) GoString

func (s ReservedDBInstance) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetCurrencyCode

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *ReservedDBInstance

SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetDBInstanceClass

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDBInstanceClass(v string) *ReservedDBInstance

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetDBInstanceCount

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDBInstanceCount(v int64) *ReservedDBInstance

SetDBInstanceCount sets the DBInstanceCount field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetDuration

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetDuration(v int64) *ReservedDBInstance

SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetFixedPrice

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstance

SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetMultiAZ

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetMultiAZ(v bool) *ReservedDBInstance

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetOfferingType

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetOfferingType(v string) *ReservedDBInstance

SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetProductDescription

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetProductDescription(v string) *ReservedDBInstance

SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetRecurringCharges

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetRecurringCharges(v []*RecurringCharge) *ReservedDBInstance

SetRecurringCharges sets the RecurringCharges field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstanceArn

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstanceArn(v string) *ReservedDBInstance

SetReservedDBInstanceArn sets the ReservedDBInstanceArn field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstanceId

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstanceId(v string) *ReservedDBInstance

SetReservedDBInstanceId sets the ReservedDBInstanceId field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *ReservedDBInstance

SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetStartTime

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetStartTime(v time.Time) *ReservedDBInstance

SetStartTime sets the StartTime field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetState

SetState sets the State field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstance) SetUsagePrice

func (s *ReservedDBInstance) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *ReservedDBInstance

SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.

func (ReservedDBInstance) String

func (s ReservedDBInstance) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ReservedDBInstancesOffering

type ReservedDBInstancesOffering struct {

	// The currency code for the reserved DB instance offering.
	CurrencyCode *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB instance class for the reserved DB instance.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// The duration of the offering in seconds.
	Duration *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The fixed price charged for this offering.
	FixedPrice *float64 `type:"double"`

	// Indicates if the offering applies to Multi-AZ deployments.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The offering type.
	OfferingType *string `type:"string"`

	// The database engine used by the offering.
	ProductDescription *string `type:"string"`

	// The recurring price charged to run this reserved DB instance.
	RecurringCharges []*RecurringCharge `locationNameList:"RecurringCharge" type:"list"`

	// The offering identifier.
	ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId *string `type:"string"`

	// The hourly price charged for this offering.
	UsagePrice *float64 `type:"double"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeReservedDBInstancesOfferings action.

func (ReservedDBInstancesOffering) GoString

func (s ReservedDBInstancesOffering) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetCurrencyCode

SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetDuration

SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetFixedPrice

SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetOfferingType

SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetProductDescription

func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetProductDescription(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering

SetProductDescription sets the ProductDescription field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetRecurringCharges

SetRecurringCharges sets the RecurringCharges field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId

func (s *ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId(v string) *ReservedDBInstancesOffering

SetReservedDBInstancesOfferingId sets the ReservedDBInstancesOfferingId field's value.

func (*ReservedDBInstancesOffering) SetUsagePrice

SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.

func (ReservedDBInstancesOffering) String

String returns the string representation

type ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput

type ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to reset.
	//
	// DBClusterParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of parameter names in the DB cluster parameter group to reset to the
	// default values. You can't use this parameter if the ResetAllParameters parameter
	// is set to true.
	Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`

	// A value that is set to true to reset all parameters in the DB cluster parameter
	// group to their default values, and false otherwise. You can't use this parameter
	// if there is a list of parameter names specified for the Parameters parameter.
	ResetAllParameters *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

func (s *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetParameters

SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.

func (*ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) SetResetAllParameters

SetResetAllParameters sets the ResetAllParameters field's value.

func (ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*ResetDBClusterParameterGroupInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ResetDBParameterGroupInput

type ResetDBParameterGroupInput struct {

	// The name of the DB parameter group.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the name of an existing DBParameterGroup.
	//
	// DBParameterGroupName is a required field
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// To reset the entire DB parameter group, specify the DBParameterGroup name
	// and ResetAllParameters parameters. To reset specific parameters, provide
	// a list of the following: ParameterName and ApplyMethod. A maximum of 20 parameters
	// can be modified in a single request.
	//
	// MySQL
	//
	// Valid Values (for Apply method): immediate | pending-reboot
	//
	// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
	// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
	// are applied when DB instance reboots.
	//
	// MariaDB
	//
	// Valid Values (for Apply method): immediate | pending-reboot
	//
	// You can use the immediate value with dynamic parameters only. You can use
	// the pending-reboot value for both dynamic and static parameters, and changes
	// are applied when DB instance reboots.
	//
	// Oracle
	//
	// Valid Values (for Apply method): pending-reboot
	Parameters []*Parameter `locationNameList:"Parameter" type:"list"`

	// Specifies whether (true) or not (false) to reset all parameters in the DB
	// parameter group to default values.
	//
	// Default: true
	ResetAllParameters *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (ResetDBParameterGroupInput) GoString

func (s ResetDBParameterGroupInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *ResetDBParameterGroupInput

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetParameters

SetParameters sets the Parameters field's value.

func (*ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetResetAllParameters

func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) SetResetAllParameters(v bool) *ResetDBParameterGroupInput

SetResetAllParameters sets the ResetAllParameters field's value.

func (ResetDBParameterGroupInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*ResetDBParameterGroupInput) Validate

func (s *ResetDBParameterGroupInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions

type ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions struct {

	// A list that provides details about the pending maintenance actions for the
	// resource.
	PendingMaintenanceActionDetails []*PendingMaintenanceAction `locationNameList:"PendingMaintenanceAction" type:"list"`

	// The ARN of the resource that has pending maintenance actions.
	ResourceIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Describes the pending maintenance actions for a resource.

func (ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) SetPendingMaintenanceActionDetails

SetPendingMaintenanceActionDetails sets the PendingMaintenanceActionDetails field's value.

func (*ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) SetResourceIdentifier

SetResourceIdentifier sets the ResourceIdentifier field's value.

func (ResourcePendingMaintenanceActions) String

String returns the string representation

type RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

type RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input struct {

	// A list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the restored DB cluster
	// can be created in.
	AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`

	// The number of days for which automated backups of the restored DB cluster
	// are retained. You must specify a minimum value of 1.
	//
	// Default: 1
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be a value from 1 to 35
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// A value that indicates that the restored DB cluster should be associated
	// with the specified CharacterSet.
	CharacterSetName *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the DB cluster to create from the source data in the Amazon S3
	// bucket. This parameter is isn't case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	//
	// Example: my-cluster1
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the DB cluster parameter group to associate with the restored
	// DB cluster. If this argument is omitted, default.aurora5.6 is used.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBClusterParameterGroup.
	DBClusterParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// A DB subnet group to associate with the restored DB cluster.
	//
	// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The database name for the restored DB cluster.
	DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the database engine to be used for the restored DB cluster.
	//
	// Valid Values: aurora, aurora-postgresql
	//
	// Engine is a required field
	Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The version number of the database engine to use.
	//
	// Aurora MySQL
	//
	// Example: 5.6.10a
	//
	// Aurora PostgreSQL
	//
	// Example: 9.6.3
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB cluster.
	//
	// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
	// key. If you are creating a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
	// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
	// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
	//
	// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
	// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
	// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
	// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The password for the master database user. This password can contain any
	// printable ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
	//
	// MasterUserPassword is a required field
	MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the master user for the restored DB cluster.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
	//
	// MasterUsername is a required field
	MasterUsername *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A value that indicates that the restored DB cluster should be associated
	// with the specified option group.
	//
	// Permanent options can't be removed from an option group. An option group
	// can't be removed from a DB cluster once it is associated with a DB cluster.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the instances in the restored DB cluster accept
	// connections.
	//
	// Default: 3306
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The daily time range during which automated backups are created if automated
	// backups are enabled using the BackupRetentionPeriod parameter.
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region. To see the time blocks available, see  Adjusting
	// the Preferred Maintenance Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
	//
	//    * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	//    * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
	//
	//    * Must be at least 30 minutes.
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// The weekly time range during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
	// Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	// Format: ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi
	//
	// The default is a 30-minute window selected at random from an 8-hour block
	// of time for each AWS Region, occurring on a random day of the week. To see
	// the time blocks available, see  Adjusting the Preferred Maintenance Window
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/AdjustingTheMaintenanceWindow.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
	//
	// Constraints: Minimum 30-minute window.
	PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the Amazon S3 bucket that contains the data used to create the
	// Amazon Aurora DB cluster.
	//
	// S3BucketName is a required field
	S3BucketName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the AWS Identity and Access Management
	// (IAM) role that authorizes Amazon RDS to access the Amazon S3 bucket on your
	// behalf.
	//
	// S3IngestionRoleArn is a required field
	S3IngestionRoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The prefix for all of the file names that contain the data used to create
	// the Amazon Aurora DB cluster. If you do not specify a SourceS3Prefix value,
	// then the Amazon Aurora DB cluster is created by using all of the files in
	// the Amazon S3 bucket.
	S3Prefix *string `type:"string"`

	// The identifier for the database engine that was backed up to create the files
	// stored in the Amazon S3 bucket.
	//
	// Valid values: mysql
	//
	// SourceEngine is a required field
	SourceEngine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The version of the database that the backup files were created from.
	//
	// MySQL version 5.5 and 5.6 are supported.
	//
	// Example: 5.6.22
	//
	// SourceEngineVersion is a required field
	SourceEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Specifies whether the restored DB cluster is encrypted.
	StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// A list of EC2 VPC security groups to associate with the restored DB cluster.
	VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) GoString

func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetAvailabilityZones

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetAvailabilityZones(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetCharacterSetName

SetCharacterSetName sets the CharacterSetName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBClusterIdentifier

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBClusterIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBClusterParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetDBClusterParameterGroupName sets the DBClusterParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDBSubnetGroupName

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetDatabaseName

SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetEngineVersion

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetKmsKeyId

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetMasterUserPassword

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetMasterUserPassword(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetMasterUsername

SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetOptionGroupName

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3BucketName

SetS3BucketName sets the S3BucketName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3IngestionRoleArn

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3IngestionRoleArn(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetS3IngestionRoleArn sets the S3IngestionRoleArn field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetS3Prefix

SetS3Prefix sets the S3Prefix field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetSourceEngine

SetSourceEngine sets the SourceEngine field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetSourceEngineVersion

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetSourceEngineVersion(v string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetSourceEngineVersion sets the SourceEngineVersion field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetStorageEncrypted

SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input

SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.

func (RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) Validate

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromS3Input) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output

type RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
	DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) GoString

func (s RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) SetDBCluster

SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.

func (RestoreDBClusterFromS3Output) String

String returns the string representation

type RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput

type RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput struct {

	// Provides the list of EC2 Availability Zones that instances in the restored
	// DB cluster can be created in.
	AvailabilityZones []*string `locationNameList:"AvailabilityZone" type:"list"`

	// The name of the DB cluster to create from the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
	// This parameter isn't case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: my-snapshot-id
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the DB subnet group to use for the new DB cluster.
	//
	// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The database name for the restored DB cluster.
	DatabaseName *string `type:"string"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The database engine to use for the new DB cluster.
	//
	// Default: The same as source
	//
	// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source
	//
	// Engine is a required field
	Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The version of the database engine to use for the new DB cluster.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier to use when restoring an encrypted DB cluster
	// from a DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
	//
	// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
	// key. If you are restoring a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
	// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
	// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
	//
	// If you do not specify a value for the KmsKeyId parameter, then the following
	// will occur:
	//
	//    * If the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot in SnapshotIdentifier is encrypted,
	//    then the restored DB cluster is encrypted using the KMS key that was used
	//    to encrypt the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot.
	//
	//    * If the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot in SnapshotIdentifier is not
	//    encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is not encrypted.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the option group to use for the restored DB cluster.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the new DB cluster accepts connections.
	//
	// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
	//
	// Default: The same port as the original DB cluster.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The identifier for the DB snapshot or DB cluster snapshot to restore from.
	//
	// You can use either the name or the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) to specify
	// a DB cluster snapshot. However, you can use only the ARN to specify a DB
	// snapshot.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing Snapshot.
	//
	// SnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	SnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The tags to be assigned to the restored DB cluster.
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// A list of VPC security groups that the new DB cluster will belong to.
	VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetAvailabilityZones

SetAvailabilityZones sets the AvailabilityZones field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetDatabaseName

SetDatabaseName sets the DatabaseName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetEngineVersion

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetKmsKeyId

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetSnapshotIdentifier

SetSnapshotIdentifier sets the SnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds

SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.

func (RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput

type RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
	DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) SetDBCluster

SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.

func (RestoreDBClusterFromSnapshotOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput

type RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput struct {

	// The name of the new DB cluster to be created.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// DBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	DBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The DB subnet group name to use for the new DB cluster.
	//
	// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier to use when restoring an encrypted DB cluster
	// from an encrypted DB cluster.
	//
	// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
	// key. If you are restoring a DB cluster with the same AWS account that owns
	// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB cluster, then you can use
	// the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KMS encryption key.
	//
	// You can restore to a new DB cluster and encrypt the new DB cluster with a
	// KMS key that is different than the KMS key used to encrypt the source DB
	// cluster. The new DB cluster is encrypted with the KMS key identified by the
	// KmsKeyId parameter.
	//
	// If you do not specify a value for the KmsKeyId parameter, then the following
	// will occur:
	//
	//    * If the DB cluster is encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is encrypted
	//    using the KMS key that was used to encrypt the source DB cluster.
	//
	//    * If the DB cluster is not encrypted, then the restored DB cluster is
	//    not encrypted.
	//
	// If DBClusterIdentifier refers to a DB cluster that is not encrypted, then
	// the restore request is rejected.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the option group for the new DB cluster.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the new DB cluster accepts connections.
	//
	// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
	//
	// Default: The same port as the original DB cluster.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The date and time to restore the DB cluster to.
	//
	// Valid Values: Value must be a time in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC) format
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be before the latest restorable time for the DB instance
	//
	//    * Must be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is not provided
	//
	//    * Cannot be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is true
	//
	//    * Cannot be specified if RestoreType parameter is copy-on-write
	//
	// Example: 2015-03-07T23:45:00Z
	RestoreToTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// The type of restore to be performed. You can specify one of the following
	// values:
	//
	//    * full-copy - The new DB cluster is restored as a full copy of the source
	//    DB cluster.
	//
	//    * copy-on-write - The new DB cluster is restored as a clone of the source
	//    DB cluster.
	//
	// Constraints: You can't specify copy-on-write if the engine version of the
	// source DB cluster is earlier than 1.11.
	//
	// If you don't specify a RestoreType value, then the new DB cluster is restored
	// as a full copy of the source DB cluster.
	RestoreType *string `type:"string"`

	// The identifier of the source DB cluster from which to restore.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBCluster.
	//
	// SourceDBClusterIdentifier is a required field
	SourceDBClusterIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// A value that is set to true to restore the DB cluster to the latest restorable
	// backup time, and false otherwise.
	//
	// Default: false
	//
	// Constraints: Cannot be specified if RestoreToTime parameter is provided.
	UseLatestRestorableTime *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// A list of VPC security groups that the new DB cluster belongs to.
	VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetDBClusterIdentifier

SetDBClusterIdentifier sets the DBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetKmsKeyId

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetOptionGroupName

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreToTime

SetRestoreToTime sets the RestoreToTime field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreType

SetRestoreType sets the RestoreType field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetSourceDBClusterIdentifier

SetSourceDBClusterIdentifier sets the SourceDBClusterIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetUseLatestRestorableTime

SetUseLatestRestorableTime sets the UseLatestRestorableTime field's value.

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds

SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.

func (RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput

type RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB cluster.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBClusters action.
	DBCluster *DBCluster `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) SetDBCluster

SetDBCluster sets the DBCluster field's value.

func (RestoreDBClusterToPointInTimeOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput

type RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput struct {

	// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
	// instance during the maintenance window.
	AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in.
	//
	// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone.
	//
	// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
	// parameter is set to true.
	//
	// Example: us-east-1a
	AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`

	// True to copy all tags from the restored DB instance to snapshots of the DB
	// instance, and otherwise false. The default is false.
	CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The compute and memory capacity of the Amazon RDS DB instance, for example,
	// db.m4.large. Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions,
	// or for all database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and
	// availability for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Default: The same DBInstanceClass as the original DB instance.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// Name of the DB instance to create from the DB snapshot. This parameter isn't
	// case-sensitive.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 numbers, letters, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// Example: my-snapshot-id
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The database name for the restored DB instance.
	//
	// This parameter doesn't apply to the MySQL, PostgreSQL, or MariaDB engines.
	DBName *string `type:"string"`

	// The identifier for the DB snapshot to restore from.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DBSnapshot.
	//
	//    * If you are restoring from a shared manual DB snapshot, the DBSnapshotIdentifier
	//    must be the ARN of the shared DB snapshot.
	//
	// DBSnapshotIdentifier is a required field
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The DB subnet group name to use for the new instance.
	//
	// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Specify the Active Directory Domain to restore the instance in.
	Domain *string `type:"string"`

	// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
	// Directory Service.
	DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`

	// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
	// Logs.
	EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The database engine to use for the new instance.
	//
	// Default: The same as source
	//
	// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source. For example,
	// you can restore a MariaDB 10.1 DB instance from a MySQL 5.6 snapshot.
	//
	// Valid Values:
	//
	//    * mariadb
	//
	//    * mysql
	//
	//    * oracle-ee
	//
	//    * oracle-se2
	//
	//    * oracle-se1
	//
	//    * oracle-se
	//
	//    * postgres
	//
	//    * sqlserver-ee
	//
	//    * sqlserver-se
	//
	//    * sqlserver-ex
	//
	//    * sqlserver-web
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the amount of provisioned IOPS for the DB instance, expressed in
	// I/O operations per second. If this parameter is not specified, the IOPS value
	// is taken from the backup. If this parameter is set to 0, the new instance
	// is converted to a non-PIOPS instance. The conversion takes additional time,
	// though your DB instance is available for connections before the conversion
	// starts.
	//
	// The provisioned IOPS value must follow the requirements for your database
	// engine. For more information, see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to
	// Improve Performance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS).
	//
	// Constraints: Must be an integer greater than 1000.
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// License model information for the restored DB instance.
	//
	// Default: Same as source.
	//
	// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
	//
	// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
	// parameter is set to true.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the option group to be used for the restored DB instance.
	//
	// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
	// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
	// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
	//
	// Default: The same port as the original DB instance
	//
	// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
	// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
	// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
	// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
	//
	// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
	// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
	//
	//    * Default VPC: true
	//
	//    * VPC: false
	//
	// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
	// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
	PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
	//
	// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
	//
	// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
	//
	// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
	TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
	// device.
	TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade

SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetAvailabilityZone

SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot

SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBName

SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDomain

SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName

SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput

SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetIops

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetLicenseModel

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetOptionGroupName

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetPubliclyAccessible

SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetStorageType

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTdeCredentialArn

SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword

SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.

func (RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput

type RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (RestoreDBInstanceFromDBSnapshotOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

type RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input struct {

	// The amount of storage (in gigabytes) to allocate initially for the DB instance.
	// Follow the allocation rules specified in CreateDBInstance.
	//
	// Be sure to allocate enough memory for your new DB instance so that the restore
	// operation can succeed. You can also allocate additional memory for future
	// growth.
	AllocatedStorage *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// True to indicate that minor engine upgrades are applied automatically to
	// the DB instance during the maintenance window, and otherwise false.
	//
	// Default: true
	AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in. For information
	// about AWS Regions and Availability Zones, see Regions and Availability Zones
	// (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.RegionsAndAvailabilityZones.html).
	//
	// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone in the endpoint's AWS
	// Region.
	//
	// Example: us-east-1d
	//
	// Constraint: The AvailabilityZone parameter can't be specified if the MultiAZ
	// parameter is set to true. The specified Availability Zone must be in the
	// same AWS Region as the current endpoint.
	AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`

	// The number of days for which automated backups are retained. Setting this
	// parameter to a positive number enables backups. For more information, see
	// CreateDBInstance.
	BackupRetentionPeriod *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// True to copy all tags from the DB instance to snapshots of the DB instance,
	// and otherwise false.
	//
	// Default: false.
	CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The compute and memory capacity of the DB instance, for example, db.m4.large.
	// Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions, or for all
	// database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and availability
	// for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Importing from Amazon S3 is not supported on the db.t2.micro DB instance
	// class.
	//
	// DBInstanceClass is a required field
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The DB instance identifier. This parameter is stored as a lowercase string.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens.
	//
	// Example: mydbinstance
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The name of the database to create when the DB instance is created. Follow
	// the naming rules specified in CreateDBInstance.
	DBName *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the DB parameter group to associate with this DB instance. If
	// this argument is omitted, the default parameter group for the specified engine
	// is used.
	DBParameterGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of DB security groups to associate with this DB instance.
	//
	// Default: The default DB security group for the database engine.
	DBSecurityGroups []*string `locationNameList:"DBSecurityGroupName" type:"list"`

	// A DB subnet group to associate with this DB instance.
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
	// Logs.
	EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// True to enable Performance Insights for the DB instance, and otherwise false.
	EnablePerformanceInsights *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the database engine to be used for this instance.
	//
	// Valid Values: mysql
	//
	// Engine is a required field
	Engine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The version number of the database engine to use. Choose the latest minor
	// version of your database engine as specified in CreateDBInstance.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to allocate
	// initially for the DB instance. For information about valid Iops values, see
	// see Amazon RDS Provisioned IOPS Storage to Improve Performance (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/CHAP_Storage.html#USER_PIOPS).
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for an encrypted DB instance.
	//
	// The KMS key identifier is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN) for the KMS encryption
	// key. If you are creating a DB instance with the same AWS account that owns
	// the KMS encryption key used to encrypt the new DB instance, then you can
	// use the KMS key alias instead of the ARN for the KM encryption key.
	//
	// If the StorageEncrypted parameter is true, and you do not specify a value
	// for the KmsKeyId parameter, then Amazon RDS will use your default encryption
	// key. AWS KMS creates the default encryption key for your AWS account. Your
	// AWS account has a different default encryption key for each AWS Region.
	KmsKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The license model for this DB instance. Use general-public-license.
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// The password for the master user. The password can include any printable
	// ASCII character except "/", """, or "@".
	//
	// Constraints: Must contain from 8 to 41 characters.
	MasterUserPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// The name for the master user.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be 1 to 16 letters or numbers.
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter.
	//
	//    * Cannot be a reserved word for the chosen database engine.
	MasterUsername *string `type:"string"`

	// The interval, in seconds, between points when Enhanced Monitoring metrics
	// are collected for the DB instance. To disable collecting Enhanced Monitoring
	// metrics, specify 0.
	//
	// If MonitoringRoleArn is specified, then you must also set MonitoringInterval
	// to a value other than 0.
	//
	// Valid Values: 0, 1, 5, 10, 15, 30, 60
	//
	// Default: 0
	MonitoringInterval *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The ARN for the IAM role that permits RDS to send enhanced monitoring metrics
	// to Amazon CloudWatch Logs. For example, arn:aws:iam:123456789012:role/emaccess.
	// For information on creating a monitoring role, see Setting Up and Enabling
	// Enhanced Monitoring (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Monitoring.OS.html#USER_Monitoring.OS.Enabling).
	//
	// If MonitoringInterval is set to a value other than 0, then you must supply
	// a MonitoringRoleArn value.
	MonitoringRoleArn *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment. If MultiAZ is
	// set to true, you can't set the AvailabilityZone parameter.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the option group to associate with this DB instance. If this
	// argument is omitted, the default option group for the specified engine is
	// used.
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS KMS key identifier for encryption of Performance Insights data. The
	// KMS key ID is the Amazon Resource Name (ARN), the KMS key identifier, or
	// the KMS key alias for the KMS encryption key.
	PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
	//
	// Type: Integer
	//
	// Valid Values: 1150-65535
	//
	// Default: 3306
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// The time range each day during which automated backups are created if automated
	// backups are enabled. For more information, see The Backup Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.html#USER_WorkingWithAutomatedBackups.BackupWindow).
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be in the format hh24:mi-hh24:mi.
	//
	//    * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	//    * Must not conflict with the preferred maintenance window.
	//
	//    * Must be at least 30 minutes.
	PreferredBackupWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// The time range each week during which system maintenance can occur, in Universal
	// Coordinated Time (UTC). For more information, see Amazon RDS Maintenance
	// Window (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_UpgradeDBInstance.Maintenance.html#Concepts.DBMaintenance).
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be in the format ddd:hh24:mi-ddd:hh24:mi.
	//
	//    * Valid Days: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun.
	//
	//    * Must be in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC).
	//
	//    * Must not conflict with the preferred backup window.
	//
	//    * Must be at least 30 minutes.
	PreferredMaintenanceWindow *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether the DB instance is publicly accessible or not. For more
	// information, see CreateDBInstance.
	PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of your Amazon S3 bucket that contains your database backup file.
	//
	// S3BucketName is a required field
	S3BucketName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// An AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) role to allow Amazon RDS to access
	// your Amazon S3 bucket.
	//
	// S3IngestionRoleArn is a required field
	S3IngestionRoleArn *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The prefix of your Amazon S3 bucket.
	S3Prefix *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the engine of your source database.
	//
	// Valid Values: mysql
	//
	// SourceEngine is a required field
	SourceEngine *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The engine version of your source database.
	//
	// Valid Values: 5.6
	//
	// SourceEngineVersion is a required field
	SourceEngineVersion *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Specifies whether the new DB instance is encrypted or not.
	StorageEncrypted *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
	//
	// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
	//
	// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
	//
	// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified; otherwise standard
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of tags to associate with this DB instance. For more information,
	// see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// A list of VPC security groups to associate with this DB instance.
	VpcSecurityGroupIds []*string `locationNameList:"VpcSecurityGroupId" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) GoString

func (s RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAllocatedStorage

SetAllocatedStorage sets the AllocatedStorage field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetAvailabilityZone

SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetBackupRetentionPeriod

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetBackupRetentionPeriod(v int64) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetBackupRetentionPeriod sets the BackupRetentionPeriod field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBName

SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBParameterGroupName

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBParameterGroupName(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetDBParameterGroupName sets the DBParameterGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBSecurityGroups

SetDBSecurityGroups sets the DBSecurityGroups field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetDBSubnetGroupName

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnablePerformanceInsights

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEnablePerformanceInsights(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetEnablePerformanceInsights sets the EnablePerformanceInsights field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetEngineVersion

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetIops

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetKmsKeyId

SetKmsKeyId sets the KmsKeyId field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetLicenseModel

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMasterUserPassword

SetMasterUserPassword sets the MasterUserPassword field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMasterUsername

SetMasterUsername sets the MasterUsername field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMonitoringInterval

SetMonitoringInterval sets the MonitoringInterval field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMonitoringRoleArn

SetMonitoringRoleArn sets the MonitoringRoleArn field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetOptionGroupName

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetPerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId sets the PerformanceInsightsKMSKeyId field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPreferredBackupWindow

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPreferredBackupWindow(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetPreferredBackupWindow sets the PreferredBackupWindow field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow(v string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetPreferredMaintenanceWindow sets the PreferredMaintenanceWindow field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPubliclyAccessible

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetPubliclyAccessible(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3BucketName

SetS3BucketName sets the S3BucketName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3IngestionRoleArn

SetS3IngestionRoleArn sets the S3IngestionRoleArn field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetS3Prefix

SetS3Prefix sets the S3Prefix field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetSourceEngine

SetSourceEngine sets the SourceEngine field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetSourceEngineVersion

SetSourceEngineVersion sets the SourceEngineVersion field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetStorageEncrypted

SetStorageEncrypted sets the StorageEncrypted field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetStorageType

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) SetVpcSecurityGroupIds(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input

SetVpcSecurityGroupIds sets the VpcSecurityGroupIds field's value.

func (RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) Validate

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Input) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output

type RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (RestoreDBInstanceFromS3Output) String

String returns the string representation

type RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput

type RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput struct {

	// Indicates that minor version upgrades are applied automatically to the DB
	// instance during the maintenance window.
	AutoMinorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The EC2 Availability Zone that the DB instance is created in.
	//
	// Default: A random, system-chosen Availability Zone.
	//
	// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
	// parameter is set to true.
	//
	// Example: us-east-1a
	AvailabilityZone *string `type:"string"`

	// True to copy all tags from the restored DB instance to snapshots of the DB
	// instance, and otherwise false. The default is false.
	CopyTagsToSnapshot *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The compute and memory capacity of the Amazon RDS DB instance, for example,
	// db.m4.large. Not all DB instance classes are available in all AWS Regions,
	// or for all database engines. For the full list of DB instance classes, and
	// availability for your engine, see DB Instance Class (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/Concepts.DBInstanceClass.html)
	// in the Amazon RDS User Guide.
	//
	// Default: The same DBInstanceClass as the original DB instance.
	DBInstanceClass *string `type:"string"`

	// The database name for the restored DB instance.
	//
	// This parameter is not used for the MySQL or MariaDB engines.
	DBName *string `type:"string"`

	// The DB subnet group name to use for the new instance.
	//
	// Constraints: If supplied, must match the name of an existing DBSubnetGroup.
	//
	// Example: mySubnetgroup
	DBSubnetGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// Specify the Active Directory Domain to restore the instance in.
	Domain *string `type:"string"`

	// Specify the name of the IAM role to be used when making API calls to the
	// Directory Service.
	DomainIAMRoleName *string `type:"string"`

	// The list of logs that the restored DB instance is to export to CloudWatch
	// Logs.
	EnableCloudwatchLogsExports []*string `type:"list"`

	// True to enable mapping of AWS Identity and Access Management (IAM) accounts
	// to database accounts, and otherwise false.
	//
	// You can enable IAM database authentication for the following database engines
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.6, minor version 5.6.34 or higher
	//
	//    * For MySQL 5.7, minor version 5.7.16 or higher
	//
	// Default: false
	EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The database engine to use for the new instance.
	//
	// Default: The same as source
	//
	// Constraint: Must be compatible with the engine of the source
	//
	// Valid Values:
	//
	//    * mariadb
	//
	//    * mysql
	//
	//    * oracle-ee
	//
	//    * oracle-se2
	//
	//    * oracle-se1
	//
	//    * oracle-se
	//
	//    * postgres
	//
	//    * sqlserver-ee
	//
	//    * sqlserver-se
	//
	//    * sqlserver-ex
	//
	//    * sqlserver-web
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// The amount of Provisioned IOPS (input/output operations per second) to be
	// initially allocated for the DB instance.
	//
	// Constraints: Must be an integer greater than 1000.
	//
	// SQL Server
	//
	// Setting the IOPS value for the SQL Server database engine is not supported.
	Iops *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// License model information for the restored DB instance.
	//
	// Default: Same as source.
	//
	// Valid values: license-included | bring-your-own-license | general-public-license
	LicenseModel *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies if the DB instance is a Multi-AZ deployment.
	//
	// Constraint: You can't specify the AvailabilityZone parameter if the MultiAZ
	// parameter is set to true.
	MultiAZ *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The name of the option group to be used for the restored DB instance.
	//
	// Permanent options, such as the TDE option for Oracle Advanced Security TDE,
	// can't be removed from an option group, and that option group can't be removed
	// from a DB instance once it is associated with a DB instance
	OptionGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The port number on which the database accepts connections.
	//
	// Constraints: Value must be 1150-65535
	//
	// Default: The same port as the original DB instance.
	Port *int64 `type:"integer"`

	// Specifies the accessibility options for the DB instance. A value of true
	// specifies an Internet-facing instance with a publicly resolvable DNS name,
	// which resolves to a public IP address. A value of false specifies an internal
	// instance with a DNS name that resolves to a private IP address.
	//
	// Default: The default behavior varies depending on whether a VPC has been
	// requested or not. The following list shows the default behavior in each case.
	//
	//    * Default VPC:true
	//
	//    * VPC:false
	//
	// If no DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is publicly accessible. If a specific
	// DB subnet group has been specified as part of the request and the PubliclyAccessible
	// value has not been set, the DB instance is private.
	PubliclyAccessible *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The date and time to restore from.
	//
	// Valid Values: Value must be a time in Universal Coordinated Time (UTC) format
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must be before the latest restorable time for the DB instance
	//
	//    * Cannot be specified if UseLatestRestorableTime parameter is true
	//
	// Example: 2009-09-07T23:45:00Z
	RestoreTime *time.Time `type:"timestamp" timestampFormat:"iso8601"`

	// The identifier of the source DB instance from which to restore.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must match the identifier of an existing DB instance.
	//
	// SourceDBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	SourceDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// Specifies the storage type to be associated with the DB instance.
	//
	// Valid values: standard | gp2 | io1
	//
	// If you specify io1, you must also include a value for the Iops parameter.
	//
	// Default: io1 if the Iops parameter is specified, otherwise standard
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`

	// A list of tags. For more information, see Tagging Amazon RDS Resources (http://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonRDS/latest/UserGuide/USER_Tagging.html).
	Tags []*Tag `locationNameList:"Tag" type:"list"`

	// The name of the new DB instance to be created.
	//
	// Constraints:
	//
	//    * Must contain from 1 to 63 letters, numbers, or hyphens
	//
	//    * First character must be a letter
	//
	//    * Cannot end with a hyphen or contain two consecutive hyphens
	//
	// TargetDBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	TargetDBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The ARN from the key store with which to associate the instance for TDE encryption.
	TdeCredentialArn *string `type:"string"`

	// The password for the given ARN from the key store in order to access the
	// device.
	TdeCredentialPassword *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies whether (true) or not (false) the DB instance is restored from
	// the latest backup time.
	//
	// Default: false
	//
	// Constraints: Cannot be specified if RestoreTime parameter is provided.
	UseLatestRestorableTime *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade

SetAutoMinorVersionUpgrade sets the AutoMinorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetAvailabilityZone

SetAvailabilityZone sets the AvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetCopyTagsToSnapshot

SetCopyTagsToSnapshot sets the CopyTagsToSnapshot field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBInstanceClass

SetDBInstanceClass sets the DBInstanceClass field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBName

SetDBName sets the DBName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDBSubnetGroupName

SetDBSubnetGroupName sets the DBSubnetGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDomain

SetDomain sets the Domain field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetDomainIAMRoleName

SetDomainIAMRoleName sets the DomainIAMRoleName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports(v []*string) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput

SetEnableCloudwatchLogsExports sets the EnableCloudwatchLogsExports field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication

func (s *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication(v bool) *RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput

SetEnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication sets the EnableIAMDatabaseAuthentication field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetEngine

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetIops

SetIops sets the Iops field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetLicenseModel

SetLicenseModel sets the LicenseModel field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetMultiAZ

SetMultiAZ sets the MultiAZ field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetOptionGroupName

SetOptionGroupName sets the OptionGroupName field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetPort

SetPort sets the Port field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetPubliclyAccessible

SetPubliclyAccessible sets the PubliclyAccessible field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetRestoreTime

SetRestoreTime sets the RestoreTime field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier

SetSourceDBInstanceIdentifier sets the SourceDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetStorageType

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTags

SetTags sets the Tags field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier

SetTargetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the TargetDBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTdeCredentialArn

SetTdeCredentialArn sets the TdeCredentialArn field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetTdeCredentialPassword

SetTdeCredentialPassword sets the TdeCredentialPassword field's value.

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) SetUseLatestRestorableTime

SetUseLatestRestorableTime sets the UseLatestRestorableTime field's value.

func (RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput

type RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (RestoreDBInstanceToPointInTimeOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput

type RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput struct {

	// The IP range to revoke access from. Must be a valid CIDR range. If CIDRIP
	// is specified, EC2SecurityGroupName, EC2SecurityGroupId and EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
	// can't be provided.
	CIDRIP *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the DB security group to revoke ingress from.
	//
	// DBSecurityGroupName is a required field
	DBSecurityGroupName *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The id of the EC2 security group to revoke access from. For VPC DB security
	// groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
	// and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
	EC2SecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the EC2 security group to revoke access from. For VPC DB security
	// groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise, EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId
	// and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided.
	EC2SecurityGroupName *string `type:"string"`

	// The AWS Account Number of the owner of the EC2 security group specified in
	// the EC2SecurityGroupName parameter. The AWS Access Key ID is not an acceptable
	// value. For VPC DB security groups, EC2SecurityGroupId must be provided. Otherwise,
	// EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId and either EC2SecurityGroupName or EC2SecurityGroupId
	// must be provided.
	EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetCIDRIP

SetCIDRIP sets the CIDRIP field's value.

func (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetDBSecurityGroupName

SetDBSecurityGroupName sets the DBSecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupId

SetEC2SecurityGroupId sets the EC2SecurityGroupId field's value.

func (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupName

SetEC2SecurityGroupName sets the EC2SecurityGroupName field's value.

func (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId

SetEC2SecurityGroupOwnerId sets the EC2SecurityGroupOwnerId field's value.

func (RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) String

String returns the string representation

func (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressInput) Validate

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput

type RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput struct {

	// Contains the details for an Amazon RDS DB security group.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSecurityGroups
	// action.
	DBSecurityGroup *DBSecurityGroup `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) SetDBSecurityGroup

SetDBSecurityGroup sets the DBSecurityGroup field's value.

func (RevokeDBSecurityGroupIngressOutput) String

String returns the string representation

type SourceRegion

type SourceRegion struct {

	// The endpoint for the source AWS Region endpoint.
	Endpoint *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the source AWS Region.
	RegionName *string `type:"string"`

	// The status of the source AWS Region.
	Status *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Contains an AWS Region name as the result of a successful call to the DescribeSourceRegions action.

func (SourceRegion) GoString

func (s SourceRegion) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*SourceRegion) SetEndpoint

func (s *SourceRegion) SetEndpoint(v string) *SourceRegion

SetEndpoint sets the Endpoint field's value.

func (*SourceRegion) SetRegionName

func (s *SourceRegion) SetRegionName(v string) *SourceRegion

SetRegionName sets the RegionName field's value.

func (*SourceRegion) SetStatus

func (s *SourceRegion) SetStatus(v string) *SourceRegion

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (SourceRegion) String

func (s SourceRegion) String() string

String returns the string representation

type StartDBInstanceInput

type StartDBInstanceInput struct {

	// The user-supplied instance identifier.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (StartDBInstanceInput) GoString

func (s StartDBInstanceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*StartDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *StartDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *StartDBInstanceInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (StartDBInstanceInput) String

func (s StartDBInstanceInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*StartDBInstanceInput) Validate

func (s *StartDBInstanceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type StartDBInstanceOutput

type StartDBInstanceOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (StartDBInstanceOutput) GoString

func (s StartDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*StartDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (StartDBInstanceOutput) String

func (s StartDBInstanceOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type StopDBInstanceInput

type StopDBInstanceInput struct {

	// The user-supplied instance identifier.
	//
	// DBInstanceIdentifier is a required field
	DBInstanceIdentifier *string `type:"string" required:"true"`

	// The user-supplied instance identifier of the DB Snapshot created immediately
	// before the DB instance is stopped.
	DBSnapshotIdentifier *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (StopDBInstanceInput) GoString

func (s StopDBInstanceInput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*StopDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier

func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) SetDBInstanceIdentifier(v string) *StopDBInstanceInput

SetDBInstanceIdentifier sets the DBInstanceIdentifier field's value.

func (*StopDBInstanceInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier

func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) SetDBSnapshotIdentifier(v string) *StopDBInstanceInput

SetDBSnapshotIdentifier sets the DBSnapshotIdentifier field's value.

func (StopDBInstanceInput) String

func (s StopDBInstanceInput) String() string

String returns the string representation

func (*StopDBInstanceInput) Validate

func (s *StopDBInstanceInput) Validate() error

Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.

type StopDBInstanceOutput

type StopDBInstanceOutput struct {

	// Contains the details of an Amazon RDS DB instance.
	//
	// This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBInstances action.
	DBInstance *DBInstance `type:"structure"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

func (StopDBInstanceOutput) GoString

func (s StopDBInstanceOutput) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*StopDBInstanceOutput) SetDBInstance

SetDBInstance sets the DBInstance field's value.

func (StopDBInstanceOutput) String

func (s StopDBInstanceOutput) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Subnet

type Subnet struct {

	// Contains Availability Zone information.
	//
	// This data type is used as an element in the following data type:
	//
	//    * OrderableDBInstanceOption
	SubnetAvailabilityZone *AvailabilityZone `type:"structure"`

	// Specifies the identifier of the subnet.
	SubnetIdentifier *string `type:"string"`

	// Specifies the status of the subnet.
	SubnetStatus *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element in the DescribeDBSubnetGroups action.

func (Subnet) GoString

func (s Subnet) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Subnet) SetSubnetAvailabilityZone

func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetAvailabilityZone(v *AvailabilityZone) *Subnet

SetSubnetAvailabilityZone sets the SubnetAvailabilityZone field's value.

func (*Subnet) SetSubnetIdentifier

func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetIdentifier(v string) *Subnet

SetSubnetIdentifier sets the SubnetIdentifier field's value.

func (*Subnet) SetSubnetStatus

func (s *Subnet) SetSubnetStatus(v string) *Subnet

SetSubnetStatus sets the SubnetStatus field's value.

func (Subnet) String

func (s Subnet) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Tag

type Tag struct {

	// A key is the required name of the tag. The string value can be from 1 to
	// 128 Unicode characters in length and can't be prefixed with "aws:" or "rds:".
	// The string can only contain only the set of Unicode letters, digits, white-space,
	// '_', '.', '/', '=', '+', '-' (Java regex: "^([\\p{L}\\p{Z}\\p{N}_.:/=+\\-]*)$").
	Key *string `type:"string"`

	// A value is the optional value of the tag. The string value can be from 1
	// to 256 Unicode characters in length and can't be prefixed with "aws:" or
	// "rds:". The string can only contain only the set of Unicode letters, digits,
	// white-space, '_', '.', '/', '=', '+', '-' (Java regex: "^([\\p{L}\\p{Z}\\p{N}_.:/=+\\-]*)$").
	Value *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Metadata assigned to an Amazon RDS resource consisting of a key-value pair.

func (Tag) GoString

func (s Tag) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Tag) SetKey

func (s *Tag) SetKey(v string) *Tag

SetKey sets the Key field's value.

func (*Tag) SetValue

func (s *Tag) SetValue(v string) *Tag

SetValue sets the Value field's value.

func (Tag) String

func (s Tag) String() string

String returns the string representation

type Timezone

type Timezone struct {

	// The name of the time zone.
	TimezoneName *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

A time zone associated with a DBInstance or a DBSnapshot. This data type is an element in the response to the DescribeDBInstances, the DescribeDBSnapshots, and the DescribeDBEngineVersions actions.

func (Timezone) GoString

func (s Timezone) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*Timezone) SetTimezoneName

func (s *Timezone) SetTimezoneName(v string) *Timezone

SetTimezoneName sets the TimezoneName field's value.

func (Timezone) String

func (s Timezone) String() string

String returns the string representation

type UpgradeTarget

type UpgradeTarget struct {

	// A value that indicates whether the target version is applied to any source
	// DB instances that have AutoMinorVersionUpgrade set to true.
	AutoUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`

	// The version of the database engine that a DB instance can be upgraded to.
	Description *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the upgrade target database engine.
	Engine *string `type:"string"`

	// The version number of the upgrade target database engine.
	EngineVersion *string `type:"string"`

	// A value that indicates whether a database engine is upgraded to a major version.
	IsMajorVersionUpgrade *bool `type:"boolean"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

The version of the database engine that a DB instance can be upgraded to.

func (UpgradeTarget) GoString

func (s UpgradeTarget) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*UpgradeTarget) SetAutoUpgrade

func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetAutoUpgrade(v bool) *UpgradeTarget

SetAutoUpgrade sets the AutoUpgrade field's value.

func (*UpgradeTarget) SetDescription

func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetDescription(v string) *UpgradeTarget

SetDescription sets the Description field's value.

func (*UpgradeTarget) SetEngine

func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetEngine(v string) *UpgradeTarget

SetEngine sets the Engine field's value.

func (*UpgradeTarget) SetEngineVersion

func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetEngineVersion(v string) *UpgradeTarget

SetEngineVersion sets the EngineVersion field's value.

func (*UpgradeTarget) SetIsMajorVersionUpgrade

func (s *UpgradeTarget) SetIsMajorVersionUpgrade(v bool) *UpgradeTarget

SetIsMajorVersionUpgrade sets the IsMajorVersionUpgrade field's value.

func (UpgradeTarget) String

func (s UpgradeTarget) String() string

String returns the string representation

type ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage

type ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage struct {

	// Valid storage options for your DB instance.
	Storage []*ValidStorageOptions `locationNameList:"ValidStorageOptions" type:"list"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance. Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications action. You can use this information when you call ModifyDBInstance.

func (ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) GoString

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) SetStorage

SetStorage sets the Storage field's value.

func (ValidDBInstanceModificationsMessage) String

String returns the string representation

type ValidStorageOptions

type ValidStorageOptions struct {

	// The valid range of Provisioned IOPS to gibibytes of storage multiplier. For
	// example, 3-10, which means that provisioned IOPS can be between 3 and 10
	// times storage.
	IopsToStorageRatio []*DoubleRange `locationNameList:"DoubleRange" type:"list"`

	// The valid range of provisioned IOPS. For example, 1000-20000.
	ProvisionedIops []*Range `locationNameList:"Range" type:"list"`

	// The valid range of storage in gibibytes. For example, 100 to 16384.
	StorageSize []*Range `locationNameList:"Range" type:"list"`

	// The valid storage types for your DB instance. For example, gp2, io1.
	StorageType *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Information about valid modifications that you can make to your DB instance. Contains the result of a successful call to the DescribeValidDBInstanceModifications action.

func (ValidStorageOptions) GoString

func (s ValidStorageOptions) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*ValidStorageOptions) SetIopsToStorageRatio

func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetIopsToStorageRatio(v []*DoubleRange) *ValidStorageOptions

SetIopsToStorageRatio sets the IopsToStorageRatio field's value.

func (*ValidStorageOptions) SetProvisionedIops

func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetProvisionedIops(v []*Range) *ValidStorageOptions

SetProvisionedIops sets the ProvisionedIops field's value.

func (*ValidStorageOptions) SetStorageSize

func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetStorageSize(v []*Range) *ValidStorageOptions

SetStorageSize sets the StorageSize field's value.

func (*ValidStorageOptions) SetStorageType

func (s *ValidStorageOptions) SetStorageType(v string) *ValidStorageOptions

SetStorageType sets the StorageType field's value.

func (ValidStorageOptions) String

func (s ValidStorageOptions) String() string

String returns the string representation

type VpcSecurityGroupMembership

type VpcSecurityGroupMembership struct {

	// The status of the VPC security group.
	Status *string `type:"string"`

	// The name of the VPC security group.
	VpcSecurityGroupId *string `type:"string"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

This data type is used as a response element for queries on VPC security group membership.

func (VpcSecurityGroupMembership) GoString

func (s VpcSecurityGroupMembership) GoString() string

GoString returns the string representation

func (*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetStatus

SetStatus sets the Status field's value.

func (*VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetVpcSecurityGroupId

func (s *VpcSecurityGroupMembership) SetVpcSecurityGroupId(v string) *VpcSecurityGroupMembership

SetVpcSecurityGroupId sets the VpcSecurityGroupId field's value.

func (VpcSecurityGroupMembership) String

String returns the string representation

Directories

Path Synopsis
Package rdsiface provides an interface to enable mocking the Amazon Relational Database Service service client for testing your code.
Package rdsiface provides an interface to enable mocking the Amazon Relational Database Service service client for testing your code.

Jump to

Keyboard shortcuts

? : This menu
/ : Search site
f or F : Jump to
y or Y : Canonical URL